blob: b85f77dab156e3438e6814be0b70edd483e0aaca [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000249
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000250 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000259 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000260 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 }
262
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000269
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000282
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000298 return &I;
299 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000301
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000316 return true;
317 }
318
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000404 };
405}
406
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000416 return 3;
417 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000422
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000427}
428
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000435 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000436 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000486
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000516
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518}
519
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000522//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000529//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000534
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000557 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000561 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000564}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000579//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000583
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000592 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000593}
594
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000602 return 0;
603}
604
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000625 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000626}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000627
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000674}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000697
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000698
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000737
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000769
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001054
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001246 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
1365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
1389
1390 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
1406
1407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001413 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001414 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1415 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1416 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1417 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1418 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1419 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001420 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001421 }
1422
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001423 // Limit search depth.
1424 if (Depth == 10)
1425 return false;
1426
1427 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1428 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1429 // are needed.
1430 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1431 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1432 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1433 // the main instcombine process.
1434 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001435 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1436 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001437
1438 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1439 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001440 }
1441
1442 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1443 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1444
1445 bool MadeChange = false;
1446 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1447 Value *TmpV;
1448 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1449 default: break;
1450
1451 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1452 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1453 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001454 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001455 if (Idx == 0) {
1456 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1457 // which elt is getting updated.
1458 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1459 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1460 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1461 break;
1462 }
1463
1464 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1465 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001466 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1468 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1469
1470 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1471 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1472 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1473 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1474 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1475 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1476
1477 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001478 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1479 break;
1480 }
1481 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1482 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
1483 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1484 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1485 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1486 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1487 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
1488 assert(MaskVal < VWidth * 2 &&
1489 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
1490 if (MaskVal < VWidth)
1491 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1492 else
1493 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - VWidth);
1494 }
1495 }
1496 }
1497
1498 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1499 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1500 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1501
1502 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1504 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1505 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1506
1507 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1508 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1509 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001510 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001511 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1512 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1513 } else if (MaskVal < VWidth) {
1514 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1515 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1516 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1517 } else {
1518 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - VWidth)) & 1) << i;
1519 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1520 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1521 }
1522 }
1523
1524 if (NewUndefElts) {
1525 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1526 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1527 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1528 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1529 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1530 else
1531 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1532 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1533 }
1534 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1535 MadeChange = true;
1536 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001537 break;
1538 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001539 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001540 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001541 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1542 if (!VTy) break;
1543 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1544 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1545 unsigned Ratio;
1546
1547 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001548 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001549 // elements as are demanded of us.
1550 Ratio = 1;
1551 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1552 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1553 // Untested so far.
1554 break;
1555
1556 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1557 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1558 // elements are live.
1559 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1561 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1562 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1563 }
1564 } else {
1565 // Untested so far.
1566 break;
1567
1568 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1569 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1570 // live.
1571 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1572 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1573 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1574 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001577 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1578 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1579 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1580 if (TmpV) {
1581 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1582 MadeChange = true;
1583 }
1584
1585 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1586 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1587 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1588 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1589 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1590 // undef.
1591 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1592 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1593 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1594 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1595 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1596 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1597 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1598 // elements are undef.
1599 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1600 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1601 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1602 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1603 }
1604 break;
1605 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001606 case Instruction::And:
1607 case Instruction::Or:
1608 case Instruction::Xor:
1609 case Instruction::Add:
1610 case Instruction::Sub:
1611 case Instruction::Mul:
1612 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1617 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1618 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1619
1620 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1621 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1622 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1623 break;
1624
1625 case Instruction::Call: {
1626 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1627 if (!II) break;
1628 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1629 default: break;
1630
1631 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1632 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1633 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1634 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1639 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1641 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1642 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1643 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1644 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1645 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1646 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1647
1648 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1649 // scalarize it now.
1650 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1651 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1652 default: break;
1653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1654 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1655 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1656 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1657 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1658 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1659 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1660 // Extract the element as scalars.
1661 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1662 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1663
1664 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1665 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1666 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1667 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001668 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001669 II->getName()), *II);
1670 break;
1671 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1672 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001673 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001674 II->getName()), *II);
1675 break;
1676 }
1677
1678 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001679 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1680 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001681 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1682 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1683 return New;
1684 }
1685 }
1686
1687 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1688 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1689 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1690 break;
1691 }
1692 break;
1693 }
1694 }
1695 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1696}
1697
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001698
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001699/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1700/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1701/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1702/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1703/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1704/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1705/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1706///
1707template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001708static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001709 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1710 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1711
1712 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1713 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1714 return F.apply(Root);
1715
1716 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1717 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001718 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001719 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1720 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1721
1722 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1723 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1724 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1725 ShouldApply = true;
1726 }
1727
1728 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1729 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1730 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1732 // and perform the reassociation.
1733 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1734
1735 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1736 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1737
1738 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1739 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001740 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001741 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1742 return 0;
1743 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001744 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001745 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001746 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001747 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001748 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001749
1750 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1751 // get to LHSI.
1752 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1753 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1755 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001756 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001757 ARI = NextLHSI;
1758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1760 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1761 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1762 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1763 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001764
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001765 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1766 // the transformation...
1767 return F.apply(Root);
1768 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001769
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001770 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1771 }
1772 return 0;
1773}
1774
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001775namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001777// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778struct AddRHS {
1779 Value *RHS;
1780 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1782 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001783 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1784 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786};
1787
1788// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1789// iff C1&C2 == 0
1790struct AddMaskingAnd {
1791 Constant *C2;
1792 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1793 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001794 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001795 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001796 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797 }
1798 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001799 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001800 }
1801};
1802
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001803}
1804
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001805static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001806 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001807 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001809 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001810
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001811 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001812 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001813 }
1814
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001815 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001816 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1817 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001818
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001819 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1820 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001821 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1822 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001823 }
1824
1825 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1826 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1827 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1828 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001829 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001830 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001831 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001832 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001833 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001834 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001835 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001836 abort();
1837 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001838 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1839}
1840
1841// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1842// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1843// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1844// not have a second operand.
1845static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1846 InstCombiner *IC) {
1847 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1848 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1849 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1850 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1851
1852 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001853 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001854 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001855
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001856 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1857 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1858
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001859 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1860 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001861 }
1862 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001863}
1864
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001865
1866/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1867/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1868/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1869Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1870 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001871 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001872 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001873
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001874 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1875 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001876 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001877 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1879 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1880 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001881 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001882 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1883
1884 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1885 // loop.
1886 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1887 return 0;
1888 }
1889
1890 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1891 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1892 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1893 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1894 if (NonConstBB) {
1895 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1896 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1897 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001898
1899 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001900 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001901 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001902 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001903 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001904
1905 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1906 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1907 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001908 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001909 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001910 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001911 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1912 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1913 else
1914 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001915 } else {
1916 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1917 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001918 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1920 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001921 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001922 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001923 CI->getPredicate(),
1924 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1925 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 else
1927 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1928
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001929 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001930 }
1931 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001932 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001933 } else {
1934 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1935 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001936 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001937 Value *InV;
1938 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001939 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001940 } else {
1941 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001942 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001943 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1944 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001945 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 }
1947 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001948 }
1949 }
1950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1951}
1952
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001953
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001954/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1955/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1956/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1957/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1958bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1959 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1960 // ones.
1961
1962 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1963 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1964 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1965 // sign extend fine.
1966 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1967 return true;
1968
1969
1970 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1971 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1972 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1973 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1974
1975 // TODO: Implement.
1976
1977 return false;
1978}
1979
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001980
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001982 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001983 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001984
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001985 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001986 // X + undef -> undef
1987 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1989
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001990 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001991 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001992 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001994 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001995 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1996 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001998 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001999
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002000 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002001 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002002 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002003 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002004 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002005 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002006
2007 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2008 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002009 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2010 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2011 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2012 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2013 return &I;
2014 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002015 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002016
2017 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2018 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2019 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002021 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2022 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002023 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2024 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002025 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002026 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002027
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002028 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002029 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2030 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002031 do {
2032 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002033 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2034 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002035 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2036 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002037 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002038 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2039 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002040 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002041 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002042 }
2043 }
2044 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002045 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2046 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2047 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002048
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002049 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002050 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2051 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2052 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002053 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2054 switch (Size) {
2055 default: break;
2056 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2057 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2058 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2059 }
2060 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002061 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002062 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002063 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002064 }
2065 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002066 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002067
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002068 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2069 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2070
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002071 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002072 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002073 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002074
2075 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2076 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2077 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2079 }
2080 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2081 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2082 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2084 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002085 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002086
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002087 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002088 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2089 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002090 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2091 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002092 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002093 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002094 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002095 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002096 }
2097
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002098 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002099 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002100
2101 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002102 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2103 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002104 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002105
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002106
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002107 ConstantInt *C2;
2108 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2109 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002111
2112 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2113 ConstantInt *C1;
2114 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002115 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002116 }
2117
2118 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002119 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002121
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002122 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002123 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002125
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002126
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002127 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002128 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002129 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2130 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002131
2132 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2133 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2134 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2135 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2136 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2137 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2138 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2139 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2140 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2141 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2142
2143 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002144 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002145 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002146 }
2147 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002148
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002149 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002150 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002151 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2152 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2153 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2154 if (W != Y) {
2155 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002156 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002157 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002158 std::swap(W, X);
2159 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002160 std::swap(Y, Z);
2161 std::swap(W, X);
2162 }
2163 }
2164
2165 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002166 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002168 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002169 }
2170 }
2171 }
2172
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002173 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002174 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002175 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002176 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002177
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002178 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2179 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002180 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002181 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2182 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2183 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002184 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002185
2186 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002187 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002188
2189 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002190 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002191
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002192 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2193 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002194 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002195 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002196 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002197 }
2198 }
2199 }
2200
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002201 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2202 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002203 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002204 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002205 }
2206
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002207 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002208 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002209 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002210 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2211 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002212 if (!CI) {
2213 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2214 Other = LHS;
2215 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002216 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002217 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2218 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002219 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002220 unsigned AS =
2221 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002222 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2223 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002224 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002225 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002226 }
2227 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002228
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002229 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002230 {
2231 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2232 Value *Other = RHS;
2233 if (!SI) {
2234 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2235 Other = LHS;
2236 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002237 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002238 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2239 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002240 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002241
2242 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2243 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002244 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2245 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002246 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002247 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2248 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002249 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002250 }
2251 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002252
2253 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2254 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2255 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002257
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002258 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2259 // integer add followed by a sext.
2260 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2261 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2262 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2263 Constant *CI =
2264 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2265 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2266 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2267 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2268 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2269 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2270 CI, "addconv");
2271 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2272 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2273 }
2274 }
2275
2276 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2277 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2278 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2279 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2280 // integer add will not overflow.
2281 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2282 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2283 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2284 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2285 // Insert the new integer add.
2286 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2287 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2288 "addconv");
2289 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2290 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2291 }
2292 }
2293 }
2294
2295 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2296 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2297 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2298 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2299 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2300 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2301 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2302 // instcombined.
2303 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2304 Constant *CI =
2305 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2306 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2307 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2308 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2309 // Insert the new integer add.
2310 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2311 CI, "addconv");
2312 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2313 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2314 }
2315 }
2316
2317 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2318 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2319 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2320 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2321 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2322 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2323 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2324 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2325 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2326 // Insert the new integer add.
2327 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2328 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2329 "addconv");
2330 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2331 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2332 }
2333 }
2334 }
2335
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002336 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002337}
2338
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002339Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002340 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002341
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002342 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2343 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002345
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002346 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002347 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002348 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002349
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002350 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2352 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2354
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002355 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2356 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002357 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002358 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002359
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002360 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002361 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002362 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002363 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002364
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002365 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2366 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002367 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002368 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002369 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002370 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002371 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002372 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002373 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002374 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002376 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002377 }
2378 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002379 }
2380 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2381 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2382 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002383 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002384 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002385 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002386 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002387 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002388 }
2389 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002390 }
2391 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002392 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002393
2394 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2395 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002396 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002397 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002398
2399 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2400 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2401 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002402 }
2403
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002404 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2405 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2406
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002407 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2408 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002409 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002410 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002411 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002412 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002413 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002414 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2415 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2416 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002417 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002418 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2419 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002420 }
2421
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002422 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002423 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2424 // is not used by anyone else...
2425 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002426 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002427 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002428 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2429 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2430 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2431 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002432
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002433 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002434 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002435 }
2436
2437 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2438 //
2439 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2440 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2441 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2442
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002443 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002444 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2445 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002447
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002448 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002449 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002450 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002451 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002452 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002453 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002454 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2455
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002456 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002457 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002458 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002459 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002460 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002461 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002462
2463 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2464 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2465 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2466 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2467 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2468 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002470 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002472 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002473 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002474 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002475
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002476 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002477 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002478 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002479 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2481 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002483 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2484 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002486 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002487 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002488
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002489 ConstantInt *C1;
2490 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002491 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002492 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002493
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002494 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2495 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002496 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002497 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002498 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002499}
2500
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002501/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2502/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2503/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2504/// signed.
2505static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2506 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002507 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2509 TrueIfSigned = true;
2510 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2512 TrueIfSigned = true;
2513 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2515 TrueIfSigned = false;
2516 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2518 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2519 TrueIfSigned = true;
2520 return RHS->getValue() ==
2521 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2523 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2524 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002525 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002526 default:
2527 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002528 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002529}
2530
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002531Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002532 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002533 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002534
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002535 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2537
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002538 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002539 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2540 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002541
2542 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002543 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002544 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2545 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002546 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002547 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002548
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002549 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2551 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2553 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002555
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002556 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002557 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002558 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002559 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002560 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002561 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002562 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002564
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002565 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2566 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002567 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2569 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2570 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2572
2573 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2574 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2575 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2576 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002578 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002579
2580 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2581 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002582 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002583 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002584 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002585 Op1, "tmp");
2586 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2587 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2588 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002589 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002590
2591 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002592
2593 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2594 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002595 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002596 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002597
2598 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2599 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2600 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002601 }
2602
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002603 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2604 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002606
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002607 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2608 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2609
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002610 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2611 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2612 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2613 // formed.
2614 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002615 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002616 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002617 BoolCast = CI;
2618 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002619 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002620 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002621 BoolCast = CI;
2622 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002623 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002624 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2625 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002626 bool TIS = false;
2627
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002628 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002629 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2630 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002631 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2632 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002633 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002634 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002635 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002636 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002637 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002638 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002639 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2640 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002641
2642 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2643 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002644 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002645 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2646 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002647 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2648 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2649 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2650 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2651 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002652
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002653 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002654 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002655 }
2656 }
2657 }
2658
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002659 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002660}
2661
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002662/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2663/// instruction.
2664bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2665 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2666
2667 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2668 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2669 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2670 if (ST->isNullValue())
2671 NonNullOperand = 2;
2672 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2673 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2674 if (ST->isNullValue())
2675 NonNullOperand = 1;
2676
2677 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2678 return false;
2679
2680 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2681
2682 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2683 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2684
2685 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2686 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2687 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2688 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2689 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2690
2691 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2692 // early exit.
2693 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2694 return true;
2695
2696 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2697 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2698
2699 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2700 --BBI;
2701 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2702 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2703 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2704 break;
2705
2706 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2707 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2708 I != E; ++I) {
2709 if (*I == SI) {
2710 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2711 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2712 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2713 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2714 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2715 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2716 }
2717 }
2718
2719 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2720 if (&*BBI == SI)
2721 SI = 0;
2722 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2723 SelectCond = 0;
2724
2725 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2726 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2727 break;
2728
2729 }
2730 return true;
2731}
2732
2733
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002734/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2735/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2736/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2737/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002738Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002739 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002740
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002741 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2742 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2743 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2744 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002747 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748
2749 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002750 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002752
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002753 return 0;
2754}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002755
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002756/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2757/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2758/// division instructions.
2759/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002760Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002761 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2762
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002763 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002764 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2765 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2766 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2767 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2769 }
2770
2771 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2773 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002774
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002775 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2776 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002777
2778 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2779 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2780 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2781 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002782
2783 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2784 // div X, 1 == X
2785 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2787
2788 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2789 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2790 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2791 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002792 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2794 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002795 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002796 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002797 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002798
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002799 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002800 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2801 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2802 return R;
2803 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2804 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2805 return NV;
2806 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002807 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002808
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002809 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002810 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002811 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2813
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002814 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2815 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2817
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002818 return 0;
2819}
2820
2821Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2822 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2823
2824 // Handle the integer div common cases
2825 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2826 return Common;
2827
2828 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2829 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2830 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2831 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002832 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002833 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002834 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002835 }
2836
2837 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002838 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002839 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2840 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002841 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002842 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002843 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002844 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002845 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002846 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002847 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002848 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002849 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002850 }
2851 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002852 }
2853
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002854 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2855 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002856 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002857 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002858 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002859 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002860 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002861 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002862 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002863 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2864 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002866 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2867 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2868
2869 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2870 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002871 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002872 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2873 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002875 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002876 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002877 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002878 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002879 return 0;
2880}
2881
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2883 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2884
2885 // Handle the integer div common cases
2886 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2887 return Common;
2888
2889 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2890 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2891 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002892 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002893
2894 // -X/C -> X/-C
2895 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002896 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002897 }
2898
2899 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2900 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002901 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002902 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002903 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002904 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002905 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002906 }
2907 }
2908
2909 return 0;
2910}
2911
2912Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2913 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2914}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002915
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002916/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2917/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2918/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2919/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2920Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002921 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002922
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002923 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002924 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2925 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2927
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002928 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2929 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002932 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002933 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002935
2936 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002937 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2938 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002939
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002940 return 0;
2941}
2942
2943/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2944/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2945/// remainder instructions.
2946/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2947Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2948 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2949
2950 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2951 return common;
2952
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002953 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002954 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2955 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2957
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002958 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2960
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002961 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2962 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2963 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2964 return R;
2965 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2966 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2967 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002968 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002969
2970 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2971 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2972 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2973 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2974 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2975 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002976 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002977 }
2978
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002979 return 0;
2980}
2981
2982Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2983 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2984
2985 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2986 return common;
2987
2988 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2989 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2990 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2991 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2992 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002993 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002994 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002995 }
2996
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002997 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002998 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2999 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3000 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003001 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003002 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003003 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003004 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003005 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003006 }
3007 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003008 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003009
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003010 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3011 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3012 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3013 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3014 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3015 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003016 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3017 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003018 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003020 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003022 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003023 }
3024 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003025 }
3026
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003027 return 0;
3028}
3029
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003030Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3031 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3032
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003033 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3035 return common;
3036
3037 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003038 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3039 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3040 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003041 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3042 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3043 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3044 return &I;
3045 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003046
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003047 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003048 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003049 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3050 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3051 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3052 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003053 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003054 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003055 }
3056
3057 return 0;
3058}
3059
3060Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003061 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3062}
3063
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003064// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3065// constant.
3066static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003067 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003068}
3069
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003070// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3071// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3072static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003073 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003074}
3075
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003076/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003077/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3078///
3079/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3080///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003081/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3082/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003083///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003084/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3085/// 0 A > B
3086/// 1 A == B
3087/// 2 A < B
3088///
3089/// <=> Value Definition
3090/// 000 0 Always false
3091/// 001 1 A > B
3092/// 010 2 A == B
3093/// 011 3 A >= B
3094/// 100 4 A < B
3095/// 101 5 A != B
3096/// 110 6 A <= B
3097/// 111 7 Always true
3098///
3099static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3100 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003101 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003102 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3103 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3104 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3105 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3106 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3107 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3108 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3109 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3110 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3111 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003112 // True -> 7
3113 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003114 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003115 return 0;
3116 }
3117}
3118
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003119/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3120/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003121/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003122/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3123static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3124 switch (code) {
3125 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003126 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003127 case 1:
3128 if (sign)
3129 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3130 else
3131 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3132 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3133 case 3:
3134 if (sign)
3135 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3136 else
3137 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3138 case 4:
3139 if (sign)
3140 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3141 else
3142 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3143 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3144 case 6:
3145 if (sign)
3146 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3147 else
3148 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003149 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003150 }
3151}
3152
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003153static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3154 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3155 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3156 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3157 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3158 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3159}
3160
3161namespace {
3162// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3163struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003164 InstCombiner &IC;
3165 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003166 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3167 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3168 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3169 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003170 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003171 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3172 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003173 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3174 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003175 return false;
3176 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003177 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3178 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3179 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3180 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3181 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003182 }
3183
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003184 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003185 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003186 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003187 unsigned Code;
3188 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3189 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3190 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3191 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003192 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003193 }
3194
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003195 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3196 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3197
3198 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003199 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3200 return I;
3201 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3202 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3203 }
3204};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003205} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003206
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003207// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3208// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003209// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003210Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003211 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3212 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003213 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3214 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003215 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003216 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003217 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003218
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003219 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3220 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003221 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003222 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003223 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003224 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003225 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003226 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003227 }
3228 break;
3229 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003230 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003232
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003233 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3234 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003235 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003236 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003237 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003238 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003239 }
3240 break;
3241 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003242 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003243 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3244 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3245 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003246 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003247
3248 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003249 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003250 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3251 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3252 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003253 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003254
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003255 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3256 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3257 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3258 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3259 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3260 // no effect.
3261 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3262 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3263 return &TheAnd;
3264 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003265 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003266 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003267 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003268 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003269 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003270 }
3271 }
3272 }
3273 }
3274 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003275
3276 case Instruction::Shl: {
3277 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3278 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3279 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003280 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003281 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003282 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3283 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003284
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003285 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3286 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3288 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003289 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3290 return &TheAnd;
3291 }
3292 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003293 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003294 case Instruction::LShr:
3295 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003296 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3297 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3298 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3299 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003300 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003301 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003302 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3303 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003304
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003305 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3306 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3308 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3309 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3310 return &TheAnd;
3311 }
3312 break;
3313 }
3314 case Instruction::AShr:
3315 // Signed shr.
3316 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3317 // with an and.
3318 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003319 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003320 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003321 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3322 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003323 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003324 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003325 // Make the argument unsigned.
3326 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003327 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003328 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003329 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003330 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003331 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003332 }
3333 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003334 }
3335 return 0;
3336}
3337
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003338
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003339/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3340/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003341/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3342/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003343/// insert new instructions.
3344Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003345 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3346 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003347 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003348 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003349 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003350
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003351 if (Inside) {
3352 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003353 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003354
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003355 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003356 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003357 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003358 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3359 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3360 }
3361
3362 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3363 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003364 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003365 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003366 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3367 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003368 }
3369
3370 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003371 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003372
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003373 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003374 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003375 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003376 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3377 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3378 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3379 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003380
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003381 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3382 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3383 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003384 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003385 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003386 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3387 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003388}
3389
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003390// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3391// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3392// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3393// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003394static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003395 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003396 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3397 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003398
3399 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003400 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003401 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003402 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003403 return true;
3404}
3405
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003406/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3407/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3408/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003409///
3410/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3411/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3412/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3413///
3414/// return (A +/- B).
3415///
3416Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003417 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003418 Instruction &I) {
3419 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3420 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3421 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3422
3423 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3424
3425 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3426 default: return 0;
3427 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003428 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003429 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003430 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3431 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3432 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003433 break;
3434
3435 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3436 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3437 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003438 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003439 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003440 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003441 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003442 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003443 break;
3444 }
3445 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003446 return 0;
3447 case Instruction::Or:
3448 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003449 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003450 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3451 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003452 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003453 break;
3454 return 0;
3455 }
3456
3457 Instruction *New;
3458 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003459 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003460 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003461 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003462 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3463}
3464
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003465Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003466 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003467 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003468
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003469 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3471
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003472 // and X, X = X
3473 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003475
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003476 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003477 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003478 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003479 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3480 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3481 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003482 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003483 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003484 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003485 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003486 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003487 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003488 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003490 }
3491 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003492
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003493 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003494 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3495 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003496
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003497 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003498 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003499 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003500 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3501 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3502 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3503 case Instruction::Xor:
3504 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003505 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3506 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3507 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3508 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003509 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003510 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3511 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003512 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003513 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003514 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003515 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003516 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3517 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003518 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003519 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3520 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003521 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003522 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3523 }
3524 }
3525
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003526 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003527 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003528 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3529 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3530 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3531 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003532 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003533 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003534 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003535 break;
3536
3537 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003538 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3539 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3540 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3541 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003542 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003543
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003544 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3545 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3546 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3547 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3548 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3549 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3550
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003551 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003552 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3553 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003554 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3555 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3556 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3557 }
3558 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003559 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003560
3561 case Instruction::Shl:
3562 case Instruction::LShr:
3563 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3564 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003565 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003566 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3567 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3568 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3569 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3570 }
3571 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003572 }
3573
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003574 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003575 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003576 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003577 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003578 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3579 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3580 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3581 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003582 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003583 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003584 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003585 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3586 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003587 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3588 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3589 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003590 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003591 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3592 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003593 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003594 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003595 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003596 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003597 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003598 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3599 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3600 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003601 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003602 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3603 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3604 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003605 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003606 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003607 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003608
3609 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3610 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003611 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003612 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003613 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3614 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3615 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003616 }
3617
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003618 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3619 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003620
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003621 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3623
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003624 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003625 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003626 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003627 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003628 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003629 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003630 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003631
3632 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003633 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3634 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003635 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003637
3638 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3639 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3640 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003641 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003642 }
3643 }
3644
3645 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003646 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003648
3649 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3650 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3651 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003652 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003653 }
3654 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003655
3656 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3657 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3658 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3659 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3660 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3661 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3662 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3663 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3664 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3665 }
3666 }
3667 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3668 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3669 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3670 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3671 std::swap(A, B);
3672 }
3673 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003674 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003675 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003676 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003677 }
3678 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003679 }
3680
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003681 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3682 // where C is a power of 2
3683 Value *A, *B;
3684 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003685 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3686 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003687 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3688 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3689 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3690 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3691 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3692 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3693 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3694 }
3695 }
3696
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003697 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3698 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3699 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003700 return R;
3701
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003702 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3703 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003704 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3705 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3706 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3707 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3708 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3709 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3710 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3711 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003712 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3713
3714 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3715 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3716 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3717 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003718 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003719 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3720 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3721 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3722 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3723 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3724 else
3725 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3726
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003727 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3728 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003729 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003730 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3731 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3732 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3733 }
3734
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003735 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003736 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3737 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003738 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3739 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3740 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003741 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3742
3743 switch (LHSCC) {
3744 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003745 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003746 switch (RHSCC) {
3747 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3753 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3756 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003757 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003758 switch (RHSCC) {
3759 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003760 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3761 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3762 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3763 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3764 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3765 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3766 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3767 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3768 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3769 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3770 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003771 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003772 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3773 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003774 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003775 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003776 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3777 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003778 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3779 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003780 }
3781 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3782 }
3783 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003784 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003785 switch (RHSCC) {
3786 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003787 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3788 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003790 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3791 break;
3792 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3793 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3796 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003797 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003798 break;
3799 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003800 switch (RHSCC) {
3801 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003802 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3803 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003805 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3806 break;
3807 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3808 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3811 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003812 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 break;
3814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3815 switch (RHSCC) {
3816 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003817 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003818 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3821 break;
3822 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3823 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3824 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3825 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3826 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3827 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3828 true, I);
3829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3830 break;
3831 }
3832 break;
3833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3834 switch (RHSCC) {
3835 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003836 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3840 break;
3841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3842 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3843 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3844 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3846 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3847 true, I);
3848 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3849 break;
3850 }
3851 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003852 }
3853 }
3854 }
3855
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003856 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003857 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3858 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3859 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3860 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003861 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003862 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003863 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3864 I.getType(), TD) &&
3865 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3866 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003867 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003868 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3869 I.getName());
3870 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003871 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003872 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003873 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003874
3875 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003876 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3877 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3878 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003879 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3880 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3881 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003882 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003883 SI1->getOperand(0),
3884 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003885 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003886 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003887 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003888 }
3889
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003890 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3891 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3892 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3893 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3894 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3895 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3896 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3897 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3898 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003899 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3901 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3902 RHS->getOperand(0));
3903 }
3904 }
3905 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003906
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003907 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003908}
3909
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00003910/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
3911/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
3912/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
3913/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
3914/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
3915/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
3916/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
3917/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
3918/// match.
3919///
3920/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
3921/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
3922/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
3923/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
3924/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
3925/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
3926///
3927/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
3928/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
3929/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
3930/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
3931/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
3932///
3933static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
3934 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
3935 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
3936 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
3937 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3938 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
3939 ByteValues) ||
3940 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
3941 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003942 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00003943
3944 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
3945 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
3946 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
3947 unsigned ShAmt =
3948 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
3949 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
3950 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
3951 return true;
3952
3953 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
3954 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3955 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
3956 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
3957 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
3958 } else {
3959 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
3960 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
3961 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00003962 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00003963 }
3964
3965 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
3966 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
3967
3968 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
3969 ByteValues);
3970 }
3971
3972 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
3973 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
3974 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
3975 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
3976 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
3977 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
3978 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
3979 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
3980
3981 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
3982 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
3983 // the and mask is.
3984 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
3985 continue;
3986
3987 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
3988 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
3989 if (MaskB == 0) {
3990 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
3991 continue;
3992 }
3993
3994 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
3995 if (MaskB != Byte)
3996 return true;
3997
3998 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
3999 }
4000
4001 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4002 ByteValues);
4003 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004004 }
4005
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004006 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4007 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4008 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4009 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4010 // their ultimate destination.
4011 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4012 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004013
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004014 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4015 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4016 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4017 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4018 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4019 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4020 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4021 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4022 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4023 return true;
4024 } else {
4025 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4026 return true;
4027 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004028
4029 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4030 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004031 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004032 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004033 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004034 return false;
4035}
4036
4037/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4038/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4039Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004040 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004041 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4042 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4043 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004044 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004045
4046 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4047 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004048 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004049 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004050
4051 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004052 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4053 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004054 return 0;
4055
4056 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4057 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4058 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4059
4060 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4061 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4062 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4063 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004064 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004065 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004066 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004067 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004068}
4069
4070
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004071Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004072 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004073 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004074
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004075 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004076 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004077
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004078 // or X, X = X
4079 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004081
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004082 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4083 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004084 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4085 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4086 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4087 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4088 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4089 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004090 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4091 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4092 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4093 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004095 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004096
4097
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004098
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004099 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004100 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004101 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004102 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4103 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004104 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004105 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004106 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004107 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004108 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004109 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004110
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004111 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4112 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004113 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004114 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004115 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004116 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004117 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004118 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004119
4120 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4121 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004122 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004123 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004124 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4125 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4126 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004127 }
4128
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004129 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4130 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004131
4132 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4133 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4134 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4135 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4136 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4137 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4138
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004139 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4140 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004141 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004142 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4143 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4144 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004145 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4146 return BSwap;
4147 }
4148
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004149 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4150 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004151 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004152 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004153 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4154 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004155 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004156 }
4157
4158 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4159 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004160 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004161 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004162 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4163 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004164 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004165 }
4166
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004167 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004168 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004169 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4170 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004171 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4172 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4173 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4174 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4175 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4176 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4177 // replace with V+N.
4178 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4179 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4180 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4181 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4182 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4184 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4185 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4186 }
4187 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4188 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4189 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4190 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4191 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4192 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4193 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4195 }
4196 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004197 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004198 }
4199
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004200 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4201 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004202 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4203 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4204 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4205 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4206 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4207 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4208 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4209 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4210 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4211
4212 if (V1) {
4213 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004214 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4215 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004216 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004217 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004218 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004219
4220 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004221 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4222 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4223 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004224 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4225 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4226 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004227 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004228 SI1->getOperand(0),
4229 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004230 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004231 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004232 }
4233 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004234
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004235 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4236 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004238 } else {
4239 A = 0;
4240 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004241 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004242 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4243 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004245
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004246 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004247 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004248 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004249 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004250 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004251 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004252 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004253
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004254 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4255 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4256 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004257 return R;
4258
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004259 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4260 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004261 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4262 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4263 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4264 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4265 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4266 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4267 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4268 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004269 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4270 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4271 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004272 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004273 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004274 bool NeedsSwap;
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00004275 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4276 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004277 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004278 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004279 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004280
4281 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004282 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4283 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4284 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4285 }
4286
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004287 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004288 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4289 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004290 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4291 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004292 // equal.
4293 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4294
4295 switch (LHSCC) {
4296 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004297 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004298 switch (RHSCC) {
4299 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004300 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004301 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4302 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004303 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004304 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4305 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004306 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004307 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004308 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004309 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4310 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004312 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004313 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4314 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4317 }
4318 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004319 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004320 switch (RHSCC) {
4321 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004322 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4323 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4327 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4328 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004330 }
4331 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004332 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004333 switch (RHSCC) {
4334 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004335 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004336 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004337 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004338 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4339 // this can cause overflow.
4340 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4341 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004342 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4343 false, I);
4344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4345 break;
4346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4347 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4350 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004351 }
4352 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004353 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004354 switch (RHSCC) {
4355 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004356 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4357 break;
4358 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004359 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4360 // this can cause overflow.
4361 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004363 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4364 false, I);
4365 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4366 break;
4367 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4368 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4370 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4371 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004372 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004373 break;
4374 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4375 switch (RHSCC) {
4376 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4377 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4378 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4380 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4381 break;
4382 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004385 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4386 break;
4387 }
4388 break;
4389 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4390 switch (RHSCC) {
4391 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4392 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4393 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4395 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4396 break;
4397 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4398 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004400 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4401 break;
4402 }
4403 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004404 }
4405 }
4406 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004407
4408 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004409 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004410 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004411 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004412 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4413 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4414 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4415 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4416 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4417 // generated.
4418 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4419 I.getType(), TD) &&
4420 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4421 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004422 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004423 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4424 I.getName());
4425 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004426 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004427 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004428 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004429 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004430 }
4431
4432
4433 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4434 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4435 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4436 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004437 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4438 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004439 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4440 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4441 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4442 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004443 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4445
4446 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4447 // rest.
4448 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4449 RHS->getOperand(0));
4450 }
4451 }
4452 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004453
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004454 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004455}
4456
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004457namespace {
4458
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004459// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4460struct XorSelf {
4461 Value *RHS;
4462 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4463 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4464 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4465 return &Xor;
4466 }
4467};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004468
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004469}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004470
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004471Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004472 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004473 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004474
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004475 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4476 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4477 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4478 // idiom (misuse).
4479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004481 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004482
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004483 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4484 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004485 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004487 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004488
4489 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4490 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004491 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4492 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4493 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4494 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4495 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4496 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004497 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004499 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004500
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004501 // Is this a ~ operation?
4502 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4503 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4504 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4505 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4506 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4507 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4508 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4509 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4510 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004511 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004512 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4513 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4514 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004515 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004516 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004517 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004518 }
4519 }
4520 }
4521 }
4522
4523
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004524 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004525 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4526 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4527 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004528 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4529 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004530
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004531 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4532 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4533 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4534 }
4535
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004536 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4537 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4538 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4539 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4540 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4541 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4542 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4543 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4544 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4545 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4546 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4547 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4548 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4549 }
4550 }
4551 }
4552 }
4553 }
4554
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004555 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004556 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004557 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4558 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004559 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4560 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004561 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004562 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004563 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004564
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004565 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004566 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004567 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004568 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004569 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004570 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004571 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004572 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004573 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004574 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004575 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4576 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004577 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004578
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004579 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004580 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4581 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004582 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004583 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4584 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4585 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004586 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004587 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4588 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004589 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004590 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4591 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4592 return &I;
4593 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004594 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004595 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004596 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004597
4598 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4599 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004600 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004601 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004602 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4603 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4604 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004605 }
4606
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004607 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004608 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004609 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004610
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004611 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004612 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004614
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004615
4616 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4617 if (Op1I) {
4618 Value *A, *B;
4619 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4620 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004621 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004622 I.swapOperands();
4623 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004624 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004625 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004626 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004627 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004628 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4629 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4630 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4631 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4633 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004634 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004635 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004636 std::swap(A, B);
4637 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004638 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004639 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4640 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4641 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004642 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004643 }
4644
4645 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4646 if (Op0I) {
4647 Value *A, *B;
4648 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4649 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4650 std::swap(A, B);
4651 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4652 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004653 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4654 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004655 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004656 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4657 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4659 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4661 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4662 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4663 std::swap(A, B);
4664 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004665 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004666 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004667 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4668 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004669 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004670 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004671 }
4672
4673 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4674 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4675 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4676 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4677 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4678 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004679 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004680 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4681 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004682 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004683 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4684 }
4685
4686 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4687 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4688 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4689 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4690 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4691 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004692 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004693 }
4694 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4695 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4696 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4697 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004698 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004699 }
4700
4701 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4702 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4703 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4704 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4705 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4706 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4707 if (A == C)
4708 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4709 else if (A == D)
4710 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4711 else if (B == C)
4712 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4713 else if (B == D)
4714 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4715
4716 if (X) {
4717 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004718 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4719 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004720 }
4721 }
4722 }
4723
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004724 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4725 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4726 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004727 return R;
4728
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004729 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004730 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004731 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004732 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4733 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004734 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004735 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004736 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4737 I.getType(), TD) &&
4738 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4739 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004740 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004741 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4742 I.getName());
4743 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004744 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004745 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004746 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004747 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004748
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004749 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004750}
4751
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004752/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4753/// overflowed for this type.
4754static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004755 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004756 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004757
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004758 if (IsSigned)
4759 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4760 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4761 else
4762 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4763 else
4764 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004765}
4766
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004767/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4768/// overflowed for this type.
4769static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4770 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004771 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004772
4773 if (IsSigned)
4774 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4775 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4776 else
4777 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4778 else
4779 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
4780}
4781
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004782/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4783/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4784/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4785static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4786 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4787 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004788 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4789 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004790
4791 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004792 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004793 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004794
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004795 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4796 ++i, ++GTI) {
4797 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004798 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004799 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4800 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4801
4802 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4803 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4804 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4805
4806 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4807 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004808 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004809 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004810 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004811 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4812 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4813 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004814 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004815
4816 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4817 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4818 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4819 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4820 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4821 else {
4822 // Emit an add instruction.
4823 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004824 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004825 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004826 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004827 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004828 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004829 // Convert to correct type.
4830 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4831 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4832 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4833 else
4834 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4835 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4836 }
4837 if (Size != 1) {
4838 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4839 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4840 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4841 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004842 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004843 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4844 }
4845
4846 // Emit an add instruction.
4847 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4848 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4849 cast<Constant>(Result));
4850 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004851 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004852 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004853 }
4854 return Result;
4855}
4856
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004857
4858/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4859/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4860/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4861/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4862/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4863/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4864/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4865///
4866/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4867///
4868static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4869 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004870 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4871 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4872
4873 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4874 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4875 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4876 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4877 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4878 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4879 int64_t Offset = 0;
4880 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4881 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4882 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4883 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4884
4885 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4886 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4887 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4888 } else {
4889 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4890 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4891 }
4892 } else {
4893 // Found our variable index.
4894 break;
4895 }
4896 }
4897
4898 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4899 // evaluate it the general way.
4900 if (i == e) return 0;
4901
4902 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4903 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4904 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4905 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4906
4907 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4908 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4909 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4910 if (!CI) return 0;
4911
4912 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4913 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4914
4915 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4916 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4917 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4918 } else {
4919 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4920 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4921 }
4922 }
4923
4924 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4925 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4926 // the index.
4927 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4928 if (Offset == 0) {
4929 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4930 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4931 // computation crosses zero.
4932 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4933 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4934 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4935 return VariableIdx;
4936 }
4937
4938 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4939 // the pointer size, so get it.
4940 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4941
4942 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4943 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4944
4945 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4946 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4947 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4948 // multiple of the variable scale.
4949 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4950 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4951 return 0;
4952
4953 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4954 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4955 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004956 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004957 true /*SExt*/,
4958 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4959 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004960 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004961}
4962
4963
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004964/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004965/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004966Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4967 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4968 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004969 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004970
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004971 // Look through bitcasts.
4972 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4973 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004974
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004975 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4976 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004977 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004978 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4979 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4980 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4981
4982 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4983 if (Offset == 0)
4984 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004985 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4986 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004987 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004988 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4989 // compare the base pointer.
4990 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4991 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004992 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004993 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004994 if (IndicesTheSame)
4995 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4996 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4997 IndicesTheSame = false;
4998 break;
4999 }
5000
5001 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5002 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005003 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5004 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005005
5006 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5007 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005008 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005009 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005010
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005011 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5012 bool AllZeros = true;
5013 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5014 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5015 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5016 AllZeros = false;
5017 break;
5018 }
5019 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005020 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5021 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005022
5023 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005024 AllZeros = true;
5025 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5026 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5027 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5028 AllZeros = false;
5029 break;
5030 }
5031 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005032 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005033
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005034 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5035 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5036 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5037 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5038 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5039 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005040 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5041 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005042 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005043 NumDifferences = 2;
5044 break;
5045 } else {
5046 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5047 DiffOperand = i;
5048 }
5049 }
5050
5051 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5052 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005053 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005054 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005055
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005056 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005057 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5058 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005059 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5060 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005061 }
5062 }
5063
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005064 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005065 // the result to fold to a constant!
5066 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5067 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5068 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5069 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5070 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005071 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005072 }
5073 }
5074 return 0;
5075}
5076
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005077/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5078///
5079Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5080 Instruction *LHSI,
5081 Constant *RHSC) {
5082 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5083 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5084
5085 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5086 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005087 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005088 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5089
5090 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5091 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5092 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5093 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5094
5095 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
5096 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
5097 ++InputSize;
5098
5099 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5100 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5101 return 0;
5102
5103 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5104 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5105 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5106 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5107
5108 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5109 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5110 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5111 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
5112 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
5113 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
5114 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
5115 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
5116 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
5117 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
5118 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
5119 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
5120 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
5121 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
5122 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
5123 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5125 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5127 }
5128
5129 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5130
5131 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5132
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005133 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005134 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5135 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5136
5137 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5138 // and large values.
5139 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5140 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5141 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5142 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005143 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5144 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5147 }
5148
5149 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5150 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5151 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5152 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5153 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005154 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5155 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5158 }
5159
5160 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5161 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5162 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5163 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5164 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5165 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5166 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5167 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5168 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5169 // zero at this point.
5170 switch (Pred) {
5171 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5172 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5176 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5177 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5178 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5179 if (RHS.isNegative())
5180 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5181 break;
5182 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5183 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5184 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5185 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5186 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5187 break;
5188 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5189 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5190 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5191 if (RHS.isNegative())
5192 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5193 break;
5194 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5195 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5196 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5197 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5198 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5199 break;
5200 }
5201 }
5202
5203 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5204 // comparison.
5205 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5206}
5207
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005208Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5209 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005210 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005211
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005212 // Fold trivial predicates.
5213 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5214 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5215 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5217
5218 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5219 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5220 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5221 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5222 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5223 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5224 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5226 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5227 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5228 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5230
5231 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5232 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5233 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5234 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5235 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5236 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5237 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5238 return &I;
5239
5240 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5241 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5242 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5243 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5244 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5245 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5246 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5247 return &I;
5248 }
5249 }
5250
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005251 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005253
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005254 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5255 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005256 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5257 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5258 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5259 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005261 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5262 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5263 // True if unordered.
5264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005265 }
5266 }
5267
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005268 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5269 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5270 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005271 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5272 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5273 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5274 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5275 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5276 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005277 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005278 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5279 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5280 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5281 return NV;
5282 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005283 case Instruction::Select:
5284 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5285 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5286 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5287 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5288 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5289 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5290 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5291 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5292 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5293 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5294 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5295 I.getName()), I);
5296 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5297 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5298 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5299 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5300 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5301 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5302 I.getName()), I);
5303 }
5304 }
5305
5306 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005307 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005308 break;
5309 }
5310 }
5311
5312 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5313}
5314
5315Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5316 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5317 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5318 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5319
5320 // icmp X, X
5321 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005322 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005323 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005324
5325 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005327
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005328 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005329 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005330 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5331 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5332 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005333 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005335 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005336
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005337 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005338 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005339 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5340 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005341 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005342 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005343 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005344 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005345 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005347 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005348
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005350 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005351 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005352 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005353 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005354 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005355 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005356 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005357 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5358 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005359 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005360 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5361 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5362 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5363 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5364 }
5365 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5366 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5367 // FALL THROUGH
5368 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005369 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005370 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005371 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005372 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5374 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5375 // FALL THROUGH
5376 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5377 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5378 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5379 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5380 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005381 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005382 }
5383
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005384 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005385 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005386 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005387
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005388 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5389 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5390 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5391 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5392 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005393 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005394
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005395 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5396 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5397 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005398 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5399 default: break;
5400 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5401 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5403 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5404 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5405 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5407 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5408 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5409 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5410 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5411 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5412 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5413 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5415 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5416 }
5417
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005418 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5419 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5420 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5421 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5422
5423 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005424 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005425 bool UnusedBit;
5426 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5427
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005428 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5429 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5430 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005431 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5432 return &I;
5433
5434 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005435 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5436 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5437 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005438 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5439 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5440 else
5441 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5442
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005443 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5444 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5445 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5446 if (Min == Max)
5447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5448 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5449 CI));
5450
5451 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5452 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5453 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005454 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5455 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5456 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5457 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5459 break;
5460 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5461 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5463 break;
5464 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005465 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005467 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005469 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5470 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5471 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5472 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5473
5474 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5475 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5476 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5477 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005478 break;
5479 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005480 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005481 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005482 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005483 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005484
5485 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5486 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5487 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5488 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5489
5490 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5491 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5492 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5493 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005494 break;
5495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005496 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005498 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005500 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5501 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005502 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005503 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005504 break;
5505 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005506 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005508 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005510
5511 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5512 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5513 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5514 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005515 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005516 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005517 }
5518
5519 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5520 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5521 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5522 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5523 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5524 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5525 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5526 if (I.hasOneUse())
5527 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5528 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5529 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5530 return 0;
5531
5532 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5533 // can be folded into the comparison.
5534 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005535 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005536 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005537 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005538 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005539 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5540 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005541 }
5542
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005543 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005544 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5545 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5546 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005547 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5548 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005549 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005550 bool isAllZeros = true;
5551 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5552 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5553 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5554 isAllZeros = false;
5555 break;
5556 }
5557 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005558 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005559 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5560 }
5561 break;
5562
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005563 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005564 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5565 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5566 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5567 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5568 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5569 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005570 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005571 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005572 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5573 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5574 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5575 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5576 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5577 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5578 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005579 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5580 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5581 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5582 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5583 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005584 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5585 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005586 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5587 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5588 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5589 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5590 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005591 }
5592 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005593
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005594 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005595 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005596 break;
5597 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005598 case Instruction::Malloc:
5599 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5600 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5601 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5602 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5603 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005604 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005605 }
5606 break;
5607 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005608 }
5609
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005610 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005611 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005612 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005613 return NI;
5614 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005615 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5616 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005617 return NI;
5618
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005619 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005620 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5621 // now.
5622 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5623 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5624 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005625 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5626 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005627 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005628
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005629 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5630 // so eliminate it as well.
5631 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5632 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005633
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005634 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005635 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005636 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005637 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005638 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005639 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005640 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005641 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005642 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005643 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005644 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005645 }
5646
5647 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005648 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005649 // This comes up when you have code like
5650 // int X = A < B;
5651 // if (X) ...
5652 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005653 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5654 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005655 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005656 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005657 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005658
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005659 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5660 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5661 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005662 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5663 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5664 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005665 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005666 default: break;
5667 case Instruction::Add:
5668 case Instruction::Sub:
5669 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005670 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5671 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5672 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005673 break;
5674 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005675 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5676 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5677 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5678 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5679 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5680 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5681 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5682 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005683 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005684 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5685 Mask);
5686 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5687 Mask);
5688 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5689 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5690 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005691 }
5692 }
5693 break;
5694 }
5695 }
5696 }
5697 }
5698
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005699 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5700 { Value *A, *B;
5701 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5702 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5703 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5704 }
5705
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005706 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005707 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005708
5709 // -x == -y --> x == y
5710 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5711 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5712 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5713
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005714 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5715 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5716 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5717 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5718 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5719 }
5720
5721 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5722 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5723 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5724 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5725 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005726 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005727 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005728 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5729 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5730 }
5731
5732 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5733 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5734 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5735 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5736 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5737 }
5738 }
5739
5740 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5741 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005742 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5743 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005744 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5745 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005746 }
5747 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005748 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005749 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5750 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005751 }
5752 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005753 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005754 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5755 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005756 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005757
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005758 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5759 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5760 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5761 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5762 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5763
5764 if (A == C) {
5765 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5766 } else if (A == D) {
5767 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5768 } else if (B == C) {
5769 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5770 } else if (B == D) {
5771 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5772 }
5773
5774 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005775 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5776 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005777 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5778 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5779 return &I;
5780 }
5781 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005782 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005783 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005784}
5785
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005786
5787/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5788/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5789Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5790 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5791 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5792 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5793
5794 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5795 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5796 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5797 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5798 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5799 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5800 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5801 // if it finds it.
5802 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5803 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5804 return 0;
5805 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005806 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005807 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
5808 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
5809 if (DivRHS->isOne())
5810 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
5811 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005812
5813 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5814 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5815 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5816 // instead of computing a divide.
5817 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5818
5819 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5820 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5821 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5822 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5823 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5824
5825 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005826 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005827
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005828 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5829 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5830 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5831 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5832 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5833 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5834 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5835 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5836 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5837
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005838 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005839 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005840 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005841 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5842 if (!HiOverflow)
5843 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005844 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005845 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005846 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005847 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5848 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005849 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005850 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5851 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5852 if (!HiOverflow)
5853 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005854 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005855 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005856 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005857 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
5858 if (!LoOverflow) {
5859 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
5860 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
5861 true) ? -1 : 0;
5862 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005863 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005864 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005865 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005866 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005867 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5868 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005869 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5870 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5871 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5872 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005873 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005874 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005875 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005876 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005877 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005878 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005879 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005880 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
5881 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00005882 if (!HiOverflow)
5883 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005884 }
5885
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005886 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5887 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005888 }
5889
5890 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005891 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005892 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5894 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5896 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005897 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005898 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5899 else if (LoOverflow)
5900 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5901 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5902 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005903 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5905 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5907 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005908 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005909 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5910 else if (LoOverflow)
5911 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5912 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5913 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005914 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005917 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5919 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005921 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005922 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005924 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005925 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005926 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5928 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005929 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5930 else
5931 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5932 }
5933}
5934
5935
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005936/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5937///
5938Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5939 Instruction *LHSI,
5940 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5941 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5942
5943 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005944 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005945 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5946 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5947 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005948 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5949 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005950 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5951
5952 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5953 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5954 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5955 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5956 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5957 return &ICI;
5958 }
5959
5960 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5961 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5962
5963 // If so, the new one isn't.
5964 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5965
5966 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5967 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5968 else
5969 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5970 }
5971 }
5972 break;
5973 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5974 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5975 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5976 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5977
5978 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5979 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5980 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5981 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5982 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5983 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5984 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5985 // bit would not work.
5986 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005987 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5988 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005989 uint32_t BitWidth =
5990 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5991 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5992 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5993 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5994 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5995 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005996 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005997 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5998 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5999 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6000 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6001 }
6002 }
6003
6004 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6005 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6006 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6007 // access.
6008 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6009 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6010 Shift = 0;
6011
6012 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6013 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6014 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6015 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6016
6017 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6018 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6019 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6020 if (ShAmt) {
6021 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6022 if (!CanFold) {
6023 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6024 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6025 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6026 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6027
6028 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6029 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6030 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6031 CanFold = true;
6032 }
6033
6034 if (CanFold) {
6035 Constant *NewCst;
6036 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6037 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6038 else
6039 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6040
6041 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6042 // compared.
6043 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6044 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6045 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6046 // result is always true or false now.
6047 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6048 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6049 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6051 } else {
6052 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6053 Constant *NewAndCST;
6054 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6055 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6056 else
6057 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6058 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6059 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6060 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6061 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6062 return &ICI;
6063 }
6064 }
6065 }
6066
6067 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6068 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6069 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6070 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6071 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6072 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6073 // Compute C << Y.
6074 Value *NS;
6075 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006076 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006077 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6078 } else {
6079 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006080 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006081 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6082 }
6083 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6084
6085 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6086 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006087 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006088 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6089
6090 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6091 return &ICI;
6092 }
6093 }
6094 break;
6095
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006096 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6097 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6098 if (!ShAmt) break;
6099
6100 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6101
6102 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6103 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6104 // simplified.
6105 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6106 break;
6107
6108 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6109 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6110 // comparison cannot succeed.
6111 Constant *Comp =
6112 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6113 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6114 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6115 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6116 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6117 }
6118
6119 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6120 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6121 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6122 Constant *Mask =
6123 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006124
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006125 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006126 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006127 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6128 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6129 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6130 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006131 }
6132 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006133
6134 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6135 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6136 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6137 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6138 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6139 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6140 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6141 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006142 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006143 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6144 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6145
6146 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6147 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6148 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006149 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006150 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006151
6152 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006153 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006154 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006155 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006156 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006157
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006158 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6159 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6160 // simplified.
6161 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6162 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6163 break;
6164
6165 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006166
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006167 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6168 // comparison cannot succeed.
6169 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6170 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6171 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6172 else
6173 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6174
6175 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6176 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6177 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6179 }
6180
6181 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6182 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6183 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006184 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6185 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006186 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6187 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6188 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6189 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006190
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006191 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006192 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6193 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6194 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006195
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006196 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006197 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006198 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6199 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6200 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6201 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006202 }
6203 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006204 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006205
6206 case Instruction::SDiv:
6207 case Instruction::UDiv:
6208 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6209 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6210 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6211 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6212 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6213 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006214 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6215 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6216 DivRHS))
6217 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006218 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006219
6220 case Instruction::Add:
6221 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6222
6223 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6224 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6225 if (!LHSC) break;
6226 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6227
6228 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6229 .subtract(LHSV);
6230
6231 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6232 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6233 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6234 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6235 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6236 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6237 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6238 }
6239 } else {
6240 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6241 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6242 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6243 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6244 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6245 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6246 }
6247 }
6248 }
6249 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006250 }
6251
6252 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6253 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6254 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6255
6256 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6257 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6258 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6259 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6260 case Instruction::SRem:
6261 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6262 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6263 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6264 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6265 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006266 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006267 BO->getName());
6268 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6269 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6270 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6271 }
6272 }
6273 break;
6274 case Instruction::Add:
6275 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6276 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6277 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6278 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6279 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6280 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6281 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6282 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6283 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6284
6285 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6286 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6287 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6288 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6289 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006290 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006291 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6292 Neg->takeName(BO);
6293 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6294 }
6295 }
6296 break;
6297 case Instruction::Xor:
6298 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6299 // the explicit xor.
6300 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6301 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6302 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6303
6304 // FALLTHROUGH
6305 case Instruction::Sub:
6306 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6307 if (RHSV == 0)
6308 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6309 BO->getOperand(1));
6310 break;
6311
6312 case Instruction::Or:
6313 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6314 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6315 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6316 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6317 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6319 isICMP_NE));
6320 }
6321 break;
6322
6323 case Instruction::And:
6324 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6325 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6326 // comparison can never succeed!
6327 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6329 isICMP_NE));
6330
6331 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6332 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6333 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6334 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6335 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6336
6337 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006338 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006339 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6340 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6341 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6342 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6343 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6344 }
6345
6346 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6347 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6348 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6349 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6350 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6351 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6352 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6353 }
6354 }
6355 default: break;
6356 }
6357 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6358 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6359 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6360 AddToWorkList(II);
6361 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6362 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6363 return &ICI;
6364 }
6365 }
6366 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006367 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6368 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006369 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6370 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6371 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6372 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6373 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6374 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6375 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6376 // smaller constant values.
6377 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6378 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6379 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6380 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6381 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6382 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6383 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6384 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6385 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6386 }
6387 }
6388 }
6389 }
6390 return 0;
6391}
6392
6393/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6394/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6395///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006396Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6397 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006398 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6399 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006400 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006401 Value *RHSCIOp;
6402
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006403 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6404 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6405 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6406 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6407 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6408 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6409 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006410 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006411 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6412 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6413 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6414 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006415 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006416 }
6417
6418 if (RHSOp)
6419 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6420 }
6421
6422 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6423 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006424 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6425 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006426 return 0;
6427
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006428 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6429 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006430
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006431 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006432 // Not an extension from the same type?
6433 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006434 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6435 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006436
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006437 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006438 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6439 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6440 return 0;
6441
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006442 // Deal with equality cases early.
6443 if (ICI.isEquality())
6444 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6445
6446 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6447 // signed comparison.
6448 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6449 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6450
6451 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6452 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006453 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006454
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006455 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6456 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6457 if (!CI)
6458 return 0;
6459
6460 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6461 // reextended to DestTy.
6462 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6463 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6464
6465 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6466 if (Res2 == CI) {
6467 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6468 // For example, we might have:
6469 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6470 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6471 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6472 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6473 // because %A may have negative value.
6474 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006475 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6476 // signless.
6477 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006478 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006479 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006480 }
6481
6482 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6483 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6484
6485 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6486 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6487 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006489 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006491
6492 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6493 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6494 Value *Result;
6495 if (isSignedCmp) {
6496 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006497 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006498 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006499 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006500 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006501 } else {
6502 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6503 if (isSignedExt) {
6504 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6505 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006506 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006507 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6508 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6509 } else {
6510 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006511 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006512 }
6513 }
6514
6515 // Finally, return the value computed.
6516 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006517 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006518 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006519
6520 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6521 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6522 "ICmp should be folded!");
6523 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6524 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6525 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006526}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006527
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006528Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6529 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6530}
6531
6532Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6533 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6534}
6535
6536Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006537 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6538 return R;
6539
6540 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6541
6542 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6543 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6544 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6546
6547 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006548 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6549 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006550 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006551 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006552
6553 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006554}
6555
6556Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6557 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006558 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006559
6560 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6561 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006562 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006563 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006566 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6567 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006569 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6571 }
6572 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006573 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6575 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006577 }
6578
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006579 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6580 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6581 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006582 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006583 return R;
6584
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006585 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006586 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6587 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006588 return 0;
6589}
6590
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006591Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006592 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006593 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006594
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006595 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6596 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006597 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6598 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6599 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006600 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6601 return &I;
6602
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006603 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6604 // of a signed value.
6605 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006606 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006607 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006608 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6609 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006610 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006611 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006612 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006613 }
6614
6615 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6616 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6617 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6618 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006619 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006620 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6621
6622 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6623 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6624 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6625 return R;
6626 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6627 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6628 return NV;
6629
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006630 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6631 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6632 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6633 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6634 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6635 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6636 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6637 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6638 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6639 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6640 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6641 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006642 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006643 I.getName());
6644 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6645
6646 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6647 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6648 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6649 // other xforms later if dead.
6650 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6651 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6652 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6653
6654 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6655 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6656 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6657 // mask as appropriate.
6658 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6659 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6660 else {
6661 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6662 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6663 }
6664
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006665 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006666 TI->getName());
6667 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6668
6669 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6670 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6671 }
6672 }
6673
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006674 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006675 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6676 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6677 Value *V1, *V2;
6678 ConstantInt *CC;
6679 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006680 default: break;
6681 case Instruction::Add:
6682 case Instruction::And:
6683 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006684 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006685 // These operators commute.
6686 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006687 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6688 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006689 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006690 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006691 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006692 Op0BO->getName());
6693 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006694 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006695 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006696 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006697 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006698 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006699 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006700 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006701 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006702
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006703 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006704 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006705 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006706 match(Op0BOOp1,
6707 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006708 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6709 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006710 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006711 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6712 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006713 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6714 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006715 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006716 V1->getName()+".mask");
6717 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6718
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006719 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006720 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006721 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006722
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006723 // FALL THROUGH.
6724 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006725 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006726 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6727 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006728 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006729 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006730 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6731 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006732 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006733 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006734 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006735 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006736 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006737 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006738 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006739 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006740 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006741
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006742 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006743 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6744 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6745 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006746 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006747 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6748 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006749 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006750 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6751 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006752 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6753 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006754 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006755 V1->getName()+".mask");
6756 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6757
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006758 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006759 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006760
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006761 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006762 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006763 }
6764
6765
6766 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6767 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6768 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6769 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6770 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6771
6772 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006773 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006774 case Instruction::Add:
6775 isValid = isLeftShift;
6776 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006777 case Instruction::Or:
6778 case Instruction::Xor:
6779 highBitSet = false;
6780 break;
6781 case Instruction::And:
6782 highBitSet = true;
6783 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006784 }
6785
6786 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6787 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6788 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6789 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6790 // operation.
6791 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006792 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006793 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006794
6795 if (isValid) {
6796 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6797
6798 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006799 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006800 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006801 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006802
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006803 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006804 NewRHS);
6805 }
6806 }
6807 }
6808 }
6809
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006810 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006811 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6812 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6813 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006814
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006815 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006816 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006817 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6818 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006819 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6820 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6821 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006822
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006823 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006824 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6825 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006826
6827 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6828
6829 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006830 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006831 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006832 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6833 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6834 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6835 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006836 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006837 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6838 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6839 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6840 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006841 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006842 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6843
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006844 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006845 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006846 }
6847
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006848 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6849 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6850 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6851 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6852 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006853 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006854 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006855 }
6856 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6857 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006858 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006859 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006860 }
6861 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6862 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6863 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6864 // generators.
6865 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6866 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006867 case 1 :
6868 case 8 :
6869 case 16 :
6870 case 32 :
6871 case 64 :
6872 case 128:
6873 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6874 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006875 default: break;
6876 }
6877 if (SExtType) {
6878 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6879 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6880 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6881 }
6882 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6883 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006884 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006885
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006886 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006887 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6888 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6889 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006890 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006891 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006892 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6893
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006894 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006895 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006896 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006897
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006898 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006899 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6900 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6901 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006902 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006903 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006904
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006905 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006906 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006907 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006908
6909 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6910 } else {
6911 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006912 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006913
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006914 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006915 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6916 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6917 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6918 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006919 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006920 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6921 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6922
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006923 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006924 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006925 }
6926
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006927 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006928 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6929 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6930 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006931 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006932 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6933
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006934 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006935 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006936 }
6937
6938 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006939 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006940 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006941 return 0;
6942}
6943
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006944
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006945/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6946/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6947/// X*Scale+Offset.
6948///
6949static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006950 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006951 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006952 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006953 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006954 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006955 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006956 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6957 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6958 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6959 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6960 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6961 Offset = 0;
6962 return I->getOperand(0);
6963 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6964 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6965 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6966 Offset = 0;
6967 return I->getOperand(0);
6968 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6969 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6970 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6971 unsigned SubScale;
6972 Value *SubVal =
6973 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6974 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6975 Scale = SubScale;
6976 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006977 }
6978 }
6979 }
6980
6981 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6982 Scale = 1;
6983 Offset = 0;
6984 return Val;
6985}
6986
6987
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006988/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6989/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006990Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006991 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006992 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006993
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006994 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6995 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006996
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006997 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6998 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6999 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7000 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7001 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7002
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007003 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007004 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007005 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007006 }
7007 }
7008
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007009 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7010 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7011 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7012 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007013
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007014 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7015 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007016 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7017
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007018 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7019 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7020 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7021 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7022
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007023 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7024 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007025 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007026
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007027 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7028 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007029 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7030 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007031 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7032 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7033
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007034 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7035 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007036 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7037 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007038
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007039 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7040 Value *Amt = 0;
7041 if (Scale == 1) {
7042 Amt = NumElements;
7043 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007044 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007045 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7046 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007047 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007048 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007049 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007050 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007051 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007052 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007053 }
7054
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007055 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7056 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007057 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007058 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7059 }
7060
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007061 AllocationInst *New;
7062 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007063 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007064 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007065 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007066 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007067 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007068
7069 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7070 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7071 // die soon.
7072 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7073 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007074 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7075 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7076 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007077 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7078 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7079 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7081}
7082
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007083/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007084/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7085/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7086/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7087/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7088///
7089/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7090/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007091///
7092/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7093/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7094/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7095/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7096/// efficiently truncated.
7097///
7098/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7099/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7100/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007101bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7102 unsigned CastOpc,
7103 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007104 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7105 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7106 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007107
7108 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007109 if (!I) return false;
7110
7111 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007112
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007113 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7114 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7115 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7116 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7117 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7118 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7119 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7120 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007121 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007122 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7123 return true;
7124 }
7125 }
7126
7127 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7128 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7129 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7130
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007131 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007132 case Instruction::Add:
7133 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007134 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007135 case Instruction::And:
7136 case Instruction::Or:
7137 case Instruction::Xor:
7138 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007139 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7140 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7141 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7142 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007143
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007144 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007145 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7146 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7147 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007148 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7149 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7150 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007151 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7152 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007153 }
7154 break;
7155 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007156 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7157 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7158 // already zeros.
7159 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007160 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7161 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7162 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007163 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007164 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7165 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007166 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7167 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007168 }
7169 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007170 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007171 case Instruction::ZExt:
7172 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007173 case Instruction::Trunc:
7174 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007175 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7176 // of casts in the input.
7177 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007178 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007179 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007180 case Instruction::Select: {
7181 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7182 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7183 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7184 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7185 NumCastsRemoved);
7186 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007187 case Instruction::PHI: {
7188 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7189 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7190 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7191 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7192 NumCastsRemoved))
7193 return false;
7194 return true;
7195 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007196 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007197 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7198 break;
7199 }
7200
7201 return false;
7202}
7203
7204/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7205/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7206/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007207Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007208 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007209 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007210 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007211
7212 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7213 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007214 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007215 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007216 case Instruction::Add:
7217 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007218 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007219 case Instruction::And:
7220 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007221 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007222 case Instruction::AShr:
7223 case Instruction::LShr:
7224 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007225 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007226 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007227 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007228 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007229 break;
7230 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007231 case Instruction::Trunc:
7232 case Instruction::ZExt:
7233 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007234 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007235 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7236 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007237 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7238 return I->getOperand(0);
7239
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007240 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007241 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007242 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007243 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007244 case Instruction::Select: {
7245 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7246 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7247 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7248 break;
7249 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007250 case Instruction::PHI: {
7251 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7252 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7253 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7254 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7255 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7256 }
7257 Res = NPN;
7258 break;
7259 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007260 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007261 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7262 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7263 break;
7264 }
7265
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007266 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007267 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7268}
7269
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007270/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7271Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007272 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7273
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007274 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007275 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007276 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007277 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7278 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7279 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7280 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007281 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007282 }
7283 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007284
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007285 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007286 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7287 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7288 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007289
7290 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007291 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7292 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7293 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007294
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007295 return 0;
7296}
7297
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007298/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7299Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7300 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7301
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007302 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007303 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7304 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007305 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7306 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7307 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7308 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007309 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007310 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7311 return &CI;
7312 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007313
7314 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7315 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7316 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7317 // non-type-safe code.
7318 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7319 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7320 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7321 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7322 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7323
7324 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7325 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7326 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7327 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7328 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7329 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7330
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007331 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7332 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7333 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007334 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007335 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007336 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007337 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7338 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007339
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007340 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7341 if (Offset < 0) {
7342 --FirstIdx;
7343 Offset += TySize;
7344 assert(Offset >= 0);
7345 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007346 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007347 }
7348
7349 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007350
7351 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7352 while (Offset) {
7353 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7354 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007355 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7356 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7357 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007358
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007359 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7360 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7361 } else {
7362 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7363 Offset = 0;
7364 OrigBase = 0;
7365 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007366 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7367 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007368 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007369 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7370 Offset %= EltSize;
7371 } else {
7372 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7373 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007374 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7375 } else {
7376 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7377 Offset = 0;
7378 OrigBase = 0;
7379 }
7380 }
7381 if (OrigBase) {
7382 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7383 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7384 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007385 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7386 NewIndices.begin(),
7387 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007388 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7389 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7390
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007391 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7392 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7393 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7394 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7395 }
7396 }
7397 }
7398 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007399 }
7400
7401 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7402}
7403
7404
7405
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007406/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7407/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007408/// cases.
7409/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7410Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7411 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7412 return Result;
7413
7414 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7415 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7416 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007417 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7418 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007419
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007420 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7421 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007422 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7423 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007424 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7425 return &CI;
7426
7427 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7428 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007429 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7430 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007431 return 0;
7432
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007433 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007434 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007435 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7436 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007437 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007438 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007439 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7440 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7441 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7442 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007443 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007444 bool DoXForm;
7445 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7446 default:
7447 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7448 // get here because of the check above.
7449 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7450 case Instruction::Trunc:
7451 DoXForm = true;
7452 break;
7453 case Instruction::ZExt:
7454 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7455 break;
7456 case Instruction::SExt:
7457 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7458 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007459 }
7460
7461 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007462 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7463 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007464 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7465 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7466 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7467 case Instruction::Trunc:
7468 case Instruction::BitCast:
7469 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7471 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7472 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7473 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007474 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7475 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007476 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007477 }
7478 case Instruction::SExt:
7479 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007480 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007481 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7482 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007483 }
7484 }
7485 }
7486
7487 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7488 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7489
7490 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7491 case Instruction::Add:
7492 case Instruction::Mul:
7493 case Instruction::And:
7494 case Instruction::Or:
7495 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007496 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007497 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7498 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7499 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7500 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7501 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007502 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7503 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007504 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007505 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7506 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007507 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007508 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7513 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7514 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007515 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007516 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007517 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007518 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007519 }
7520 break;
7521 case Instruction::SDiv:
7522 case Instruction::UDiv:
7523 case Instruction::SRem:
7524 case Instruction::URem:
7525 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7526 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7527 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7528 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7529 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007530 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7531 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007532 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7533 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7534 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7535 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007536 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007537 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7538 }
7539 }
7540 break;
7541
7542 case Instruction::Shl:
7543 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7544 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7545 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7546 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7547 // in the value.
7548 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7549 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007550 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7551 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7552 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007553 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007554 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007555 }
7556 break;
7557 case Instruction::AShr:
7558 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7559 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7560 // simplifications.
7561 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7562 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007563 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007564 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7565 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007566 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007567 }
7568 }
7569 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007570 }
7571 return 0;
7572}
7573
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007574Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007575 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7576 return Result;
7577
7578 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7579 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007580 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7581 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007582
7583 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7584 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7585 default: break;
7586 case Instruction::LShr:
7587 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7588 // are already zeros.
7589 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007590 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007591
7592 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007593 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007594 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7595 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007596 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7598
7599 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7600 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007601 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7602 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7603 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007604 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007605 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007606 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7607
7608 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7609 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7610 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007611 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007612 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7613
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007614 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007615 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007616 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007617 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007618 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7619 "tmp"), CI);
7620 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007621 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007622 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007623 }
7624 break;
7625 }
7626 }
7627
7628 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007629}
7630
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007631/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7632/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7633Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7634 bool DoXform) {
7635 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7636 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7637 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7638 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7639 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7640
7641 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7642 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7643 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7644 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7645 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7646
7647 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7648 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7649 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007650 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007651 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7652 CI);
7653 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007654 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007655 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7656
7657 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7658 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007659 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007660 In->getName()+".not"),
7661 CI);
7662 }
7663
7664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7665 }
7666
7667
7668
7669 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7670 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7671 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7672 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7673 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7674 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7675 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7676 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7677 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7678 // This only works for EQ and NE
7679 ICI->isEquality()) {
7680 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7681 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7682 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7683 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7684 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7685
7686 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7687 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7688 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7689
7690 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7691 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7692 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7693 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7694 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7695 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7697 }
7698
7699 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7700 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7701 if (ShiftAmt) {
7702 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7703 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007704 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007705 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7706 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7707 }
7708
7709 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7710 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007711 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007712 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7713 }
7714
7715 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7717 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007718 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007719 }
7720 }
7721 }
7722
7723 return 0;
7724}
7725
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007726Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007727 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7728 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7729 return Result;
7730
7731 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7732
7733 // If this is a cast of a cast
7734 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007735 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7736 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7737 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7738 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7739 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7740 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007741 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7742 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7743 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007744 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7745 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7746 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007747 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007748 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007749 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007750 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007751 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7752 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7753 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7754 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007755 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007756 }
7757 return And;
7758 }
7759 }
7760 }
7761
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007762 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7763 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007764
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007765 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7766 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7767 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7768 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7769 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7770 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7771 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7772 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7773 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7774 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7775 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007776 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007777 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007778 }
7779
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007780 return 0;
7781}
7782
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007783Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007784 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7785 return I;
7786
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007787 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7788
7789 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7790 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7791 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7792 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7793 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7794 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7795 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7796 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7797
7798 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7799 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7800 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7801 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7802 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7803 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7804 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007805 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007806 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007807 CI);
7808 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007809 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007810 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7811
7812 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007813 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007814 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7815
7816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7817 }
7818 }
7819 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007820
7821 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7822 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7823 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7824 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7825 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7826 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7827 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7828 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7829
7830 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7831 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7832 // bits, it is already ready.
7833 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7835 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7836 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7837 // bits, just sext from i32.
7838 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7839 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7840 } else {
7841 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7842 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7843 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7844 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7845 }
7846 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00007847
7848 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
7849 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
7850 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
7851 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
7852 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
7853 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
7854 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
7855 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
7856 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
7857 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
7858 // into:
7859 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
7860 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
7861 Value *A = 0;
7862 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
7863 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
7864 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
7865 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
7866 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
7867 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7868 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7869 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7870 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
7871 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
7872 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
7873 CI.getName()), CI);
7874 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
7875 }
7876 }
7877
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007878 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007879}
7880
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007881/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7882/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007883static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00007884 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007885 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00007886 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
7887 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007888 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007889 return 0;
7890}
7891
7892/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7893/// through it until we get the source value.
7894static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7895 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7896 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7897 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7898
7899 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7900 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7901 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7902 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7903 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7904 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7905 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007906 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007907 return V;
7908 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7909 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007910 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007911 return V;
7912 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7913 }
7914
7915 return V;
7916}
7917
7918Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7919 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7920 return I;
7921
7922 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7923 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7924 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7925 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7926 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7927 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7928 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7929 default: break;
7930 case Instruction::Add:
7931 case Instruction::Sub:
7932 case Instruction::Mul:
7933 case Instruction::FDiv:
7934 case Instruction::FRem:
7935 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7936 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7937 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7938 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7939 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7940 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7941 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7942 // the cast, do this xform.
7943 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7944 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7945 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7946 CI.getType(), CI);
7947 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7948 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007949 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007950 }
7951 }
7952 break;
7953 }
7954 }
7955 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007956}
7957
7958Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7959 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7960}
7961
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007962Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007963 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7964 if (OpI == 0)
7965 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7966
7967 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
7968 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
7969 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7970 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7971 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7972 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7973 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7974 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7975 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
7976 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007978
7979 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007980}
7981
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007982Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007983 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7984 if (OpI == 0)
7985 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7986
7987 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
7988 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
7989 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7990 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7991 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7992 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7993 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7994 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7995 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
7996 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007998
7999 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008000}
8001
8002Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8003 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8004}
8005
8006Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8007 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8008}
8009
8010Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008011 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008012}
8013
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008014Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8015 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8016 return I;
8017
8018 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8019 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8020
8021 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8022 ConstantInt *Cst;
8023 Value *X;
8024 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8025 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8026 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8027 // is a single-index GEP.
8028 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8029 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008030 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008031
8032 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8033 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8034 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8035
8036 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8037 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8038 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008039 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008040 }
8041 }
8042 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8043 // struct etc.
8044 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8045 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8046 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8047 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8048
8049 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8050 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8051
8052 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8053 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8054 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8055
8056 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8057 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8058 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8059
8060 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8061 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008062 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008063 }
8064 }
8065 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008066}
8067
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008068Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008069 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8070 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8071 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8072 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8073 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8074
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008075 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008076 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8077 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008078 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8079 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8080 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008081 } else {
8082 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8083 return Result;
8084 }
8085
8086
8087 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8088 // be replaced by the operand.
8089 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8090 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8091
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008092 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008093 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8094 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8095 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8096
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008097 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8098 // required for changing types.
8099 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8100 return 0;
8101
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008102 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8103 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8104 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8105 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8106 return V;
8107
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008108 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8109 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008110 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8111 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8112 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8113 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8114 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8115 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8116 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8117 ++NumZeros;
8118 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008119
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008120 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8121 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8122 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008123 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8124 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008125 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008126 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008127
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008128 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8129 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8130 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8131 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008132 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
8133 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008134 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
8135 CastInst *Tmp;
8136 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8137 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8138 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8139 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8140 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8141 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8142 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008143 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8144 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8145 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8146 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008147 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8148 // know the vector types match #elts.
8149 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008150 }
8151 }
8152 }
8153 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008154 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008155}
8156
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008157/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8158/// %C = or %A, %B
8159/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8160/// into:
8161/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8162/// %D = or %A, %C
8163///
8164/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8165/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8166/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8167///
8168static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8169 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8170 case Instruction::Add:
8171 case Instruction::Mul:
8172 case Instruction::And:
8173 case Instruction::Or:
8174 case Instruction::Xor:
8175 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8176 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8177 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008178 case Instruction::LShr:
8179 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008180 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008181 default:
8182 return 0; // Cannot fold
8183 }
8184}
8185
8186/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8187/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8188static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8189 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8190 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8191 case Instruction::Add:
8192 case Instruction::Sub:
8193 case Instruction::Or:
8194 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008195 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008196 case Instruction::LShr:
8197 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008198 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008199 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008200 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008201 case Instruction::Mul:
8202 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8203 }
8204}
8205
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008206/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8207/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8208Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8209 Instruction *FI) {
8210 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8211 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8212 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008213 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008214 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8215 return 0;
8216 } else {
8217 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8218 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008219
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008220 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008221 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8222 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008223 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008224 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008225 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008226 }
8227
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008228 // Only handle binary operators here.
8229 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008230 return 0;
8231
8232 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8233 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8234 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8235 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8236 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8237 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8238 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8239 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8240 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8241 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8242 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8243 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8244 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8245 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8246 return 0;
8247 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8248 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8249 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8250 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8251 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8252 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8253 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8254 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8255 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8256 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8257 } else {
8258 return 0;
8259 }
8260
8261 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008262 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8263 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008264 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8265
8266 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8267 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008268 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008269 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008270 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008271 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008272 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8273 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008274}
8275
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008276/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8277/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8278///
8279Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8280 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8281 bool Changed = false;
8282 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8283 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8284 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8285 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8286 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8287
8288 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8289 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8290 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8291 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
8292 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS))
8293 switch (Pred) {
8294 default: break;
8295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8296 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8297 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8298 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8299 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8300 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8301 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8302 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8303 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8304 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8305 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8306 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8307 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8308 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8309 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8310 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8311 Changed = true;
8312 }
8313 break;
8314 }
8315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8316 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8317 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8318 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8320 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8321 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8322 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8323 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8324 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8325 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8326 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8327 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8328 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8329 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8330 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8331 Changed = true;
8332 }
8333 break;
8334 }
8335 }
8336
8337 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8338 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8339 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8341 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8342 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8344 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8345
8346 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8347 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8348 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8350 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8351 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8353 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8354 }
8355
8356 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8357
8358 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8359}
8360
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008361Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008362 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8363 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8364 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8365
8366 // select true, X, Y -> X
8367 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008368 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008370
8371 // select C, X, X -> X
8372 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8374
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008375 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8377 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8379 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8380 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8381 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8382 else
8383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8384 }
8385
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008386 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008387 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008388 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008389 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008390 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008391 } else {
8392 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8393 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008394 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008395 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008396 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008397 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008398 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008399 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008400 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008401 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008402 } else {
8403 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8404 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008405 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008406 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008407 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008408 }
8409 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008410
8411 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8412 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8413 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008414 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008415 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008416 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008417 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008418
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008419 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8420 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8421 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008422 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008423 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008424 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008425 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008426 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008427 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008428 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008429 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008430 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008431 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008432
8433 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008434
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008435 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008436
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008437 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008438 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008439 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008440 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008441 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008442 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008443 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008444 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008445 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008446 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008447 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008448 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8449
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008450 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8451 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8452 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008453 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8454 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008455 if (SRASize < SISize)
8456 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8457 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8458 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008459 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008460 }
8461 }
8462
8463
8464 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008465 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008466 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8467 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008468 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008469 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008470 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8471 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8472 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008473 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8474 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8475 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008476 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8477 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008478 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8479 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008480 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008481 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008482 Value *V = ICA;
8483 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008484 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008485 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8487 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008488 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008489 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008490
8491 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008492 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8493 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008494 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008495 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8496 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8497 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8498 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8499 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8500 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8501 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8502 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8503 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008504 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008505 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008506 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008507 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008508 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008509 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008510
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008511 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008512 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008513 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8514 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8515 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8516 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8517 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8518 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8519 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8520 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8521 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8523 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008524 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008525 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8526 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008527 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008528 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008529 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008530 }
8531
8532 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008533 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8534 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8535 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008536
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008537 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8538 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8539 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008540 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8541
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008542 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8543 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8544 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8545 return IV;
8546
8547 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8548 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008549 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8550 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8551 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8552 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8553 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8554 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8555 }
8556
8557 if (AddOp) {
8558 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8559 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8560 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8561 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8562 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8563 }
8564
8565 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008566 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8567 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8568 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8569 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8570 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8571 } else {
8572 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008573 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008574 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008575
8576 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8577 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8578 if (AddOp != TI)
8579 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8580 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008581 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8582 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008583
8584 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008585 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008586 }
8587 }
8588 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008589
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008590 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008591 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008592 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8593 // transformation we are doing here.
8594 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8595 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8596 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8597 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8598 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8599 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8600 OpToFold = 1;
8601 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8602 OpToFold = 2;
8603 }
8604
8605 if (OpToFold) {
8606 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008607 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008608 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8609 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008610 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008611 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008612 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008613 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008614 else {
8615 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8616 }
8617 }
8618 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008619
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008620 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8621 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8622 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8623 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8624 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8625 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8626 OpToFold = 1;
8627 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8628 OpToFold = 2;
8629 }
8630
8631 if (OpToFold) {
8632 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008633 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008634 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8635 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008636 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008637 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008638 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008639 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008640 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008641 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008642 }
8643 }
8644 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008645
8646 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8647 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8648 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8649 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8650 return &SI;
8651 }
8652
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008653 return 0;
8654}
8655
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008656/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8657/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8658/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8659/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8660/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8661///
8662static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8663 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008664
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008665 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8666 if (!U) return Align;
8667
8668 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8669 default: break;
8670 case Instruction::BitCast:
8671 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8672 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008673 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8674 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008675 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008676 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8677 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008678 AllZeroOperands = false;
8679 break;
8680 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008681
8682 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8683 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008684 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008685 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008686 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008687 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008688 }
8689
8690 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8691 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8692 // of the global.
8693 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8694 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8695 Align = PrefAlign;
8696 }
8697 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8698 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8699 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8700 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8701 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8702 Align = PrefAlign;
8703 }
8704 }
8705
8706 return Align;
8707}
8708
8709/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8710/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8711/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8712/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8713unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8714 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8715 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8716 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8717 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8718 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8719 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8720 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8721 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8722
8723 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8724 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8725
8726 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8727 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008728}
8729
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008730Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008731 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8732 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008733 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8734 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8735
8736 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8737 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8738 return MI;
8739 }
8740
8741 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8742 // load/store.
8743 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8744 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8745
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008746 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8747 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8748 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8749 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008750 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008751 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8752
8753 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008754 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008755
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008756 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008757 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008758
8759 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8760 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8761 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8762 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8763 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8764 // integer datatype.
8765 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8766 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8767 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8768 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8769 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008770 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008771 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8772 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8773 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8774 else
8775 break;
8776 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8777 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8778 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8779 else
8780 break;
8781 } else
8782 break;
8783 }
8784
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008785 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008786 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8787 }
8788 }
8789
8790
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008791 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8792 // infer, use it.
8793 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8794 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8795
8796 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8797 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008798 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8799 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8800 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8801
8802 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8803 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8804 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008805}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008806
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008807Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8808 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8809 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8810 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8811 return MI;
8812 }
8813
8814 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8815 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8816 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8817 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8818 return 0;
8819 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8820 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8821
8822 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8823 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8824
8825 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8826 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8827 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8828
8829 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8830 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8831
8832 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8833 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8834
8835 // Extract the fill value and store.
8836 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8837 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8838 Alignment), *MI);
8839
8840 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8841 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8842 return MI;
8843 }
8844
8845 return 0;
8846}
8847
8848
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008849/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8850/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8851/// the heavy lifting.
8852///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008853Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008854 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8855 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8856
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008857 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8858 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008859 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008860 bool Changed = false;
8861
8862 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8863 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8864 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8865
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008866 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008867 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008868 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8869 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8870 // alignment is sufficient.
8871 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008872 }
8873
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008874 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8875 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8876 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008877 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008878 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8879 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8880 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008881 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8882 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8883 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008884 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008885 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8886 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008887 Changed = true;
8888 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008889
8890 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8891 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8892 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008893 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008894
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008895 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8896 // set, update the alignment.
8897 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008898 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8899 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008900 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8901 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8902 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008903 }
8904
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008905 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008906 }
8907
8908 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8909 default: break;
8910 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8911 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8912 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8913 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8915 break;
8916 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8917 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8918 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8919 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8920 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8921 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8922 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8923 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8924 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8925 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8926 CI);
8927 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008928 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008929 break;
8930 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8931 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8932 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8933 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8934 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8935 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8936 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8937 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8938 }
8939 break;
8940 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8941 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8942 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008943 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8944 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8945 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8946 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8947 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8948 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8949 }
8950 break;
8951
8952 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8953 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8954 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8955 uint64_t UndefElts;
8956 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8957 UndefElts)) {
8958 II->setOperand(1, V);
8959 return II;
8960 }
8961 break;
8962 }
8963
8964 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8965 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8966 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8967 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008968
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008969 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8970 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8971 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8972 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8973 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8974 AllEltsOk = false;
8975 break;
8976 }
8977 }
8978
8979 if (AllEltsOk) {
8980 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8981 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8982 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8983 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008984
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008985 // Only extract each element once.
8986 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8987 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8988
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008989 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008990 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8991 continue;
8992 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8993 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8994
8995 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8996 Instruction *Elt =
8997 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8998 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8999 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009000 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009001
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009002 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9003 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9004 i, "tmp");
9005 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009006 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009007 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009008 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009009 }
9010 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009011
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009012 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9013 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9014 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9015 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9016 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9017 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9018 if (&*++BI == II)
9019 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009020 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009021 }
9022
9023 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9024 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9025 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9026 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9027 bool CannotRemove = false;
9028 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9029 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9030 CannotRemove = true;
9031 break;
9032 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009033 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9034 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9035 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9036 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9037 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9038 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9039 } else {
9040 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9041 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009042 CannotRemove = true;
9043 break;
9044 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009045 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009046 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009047
9048 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9049 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9050 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9051 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9052 break;
9053 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009054 }
9055
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009056 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009057}
9058
9059// InvokeInst simplification
9060//
9061Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009062 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009063}
9064
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009065/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9066/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009067static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9068 const CastInst * const CI,
9069 const TargetData * const TD,
9070 const int ix) {
9071 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9072 return false;
9073
9074 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9075 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9076 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009077 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009078 return true;
9079
9080 const Type* SrcTy =
9081 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9082 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9083 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9084 return false;
9085 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9086 return false;
9087 return true;
9088}
9089
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009090// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9091//
9092Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009093 bool Changed = false;
9094
9095 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9096 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009097 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9098
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009099 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009100
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009101 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9102 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9103 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9104 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9105 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009106 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009107 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9108 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009109 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9110 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9111 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9112 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9113 return 0;
9114 }
9115
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009116 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9117 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9118 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9119 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009120 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009121 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009122 CS.getInstruction());
9123
9124 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9125 CS.getInstruction()->
9126 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9127
9128 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9129 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009130 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9131 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009132 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009133 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9134 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009135
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009136 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9137 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9138 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9139 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9140
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009141 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9142 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9143 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009144 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009145 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9146 // the call.
9147 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009148 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9149 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9150 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9151 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9152 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009153 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009154 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009155 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009156
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009157 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009158 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009159 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009160 Changed = true;
9161 }
9162
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009163 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009164}
9165
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009166// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9167// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9168//
9169bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9170 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9171 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009172 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9173 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009174 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009175 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009176 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009177 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009178
9179 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9180 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9181 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9182 //
9183 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9184 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009185 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009186
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009187 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009188 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9189
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009190 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009191 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009192 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009193 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9194 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9195 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009196 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009197 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009198
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009199 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009200 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009201 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009202 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9203
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009204 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009205 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009206 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009207 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9208 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009209
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009210 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9211 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9212 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9213 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9214 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9215 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9216 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9217 UI != E; ++UI)
9218 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9219 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009220 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009221 return false;
9222 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009223
9224 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9225 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009226
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009227 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9228 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9229 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009230 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009231
9232 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009233 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9234
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009235 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9236 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009237 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009238
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009239 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9240 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009241 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009242 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9243 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009244 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009245 }
9246
9247 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009248 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009249 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009250
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009251 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9252 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009253 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009254 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9255 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009256 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9257 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009258 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009259 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009260 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009261 return false;
9262 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009263
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009264 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9265 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9266 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9267 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009268 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009269 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9270
9271 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009272 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009273
9274 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9275 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009276 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009277
9278 // Add the new return attributes.
9279 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009280 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009281
9282 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9283 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9284 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9285 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9286 Args.push_back(*AI);
9287 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009288 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009289 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009290 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009291 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009292 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009293
9294 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009295 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009296 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009297 }
9298
9299 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9300 // now...
9301 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9302 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9303
9304 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009305 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009306 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009307 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9308 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009309 } else {
9310 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9311 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9312 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9313 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9314 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009315 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9316 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009317 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009318 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9319 Args.push_back(Cast);
9320 } else {
9321 Args.push_back(*AI);
9322 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009323
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009324 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009325 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009326 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009327 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009328 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009329 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009330
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009331 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9332 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9333
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009334 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009335 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009336
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009337 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009338
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009339 Instruction *NC;
9340 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009341 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009342 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9343 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009344 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009345 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009346 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009347 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9348 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009349 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9350 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009351 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009352 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009353 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009354 }
9355
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009356 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009357 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009358 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009359 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009360 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009361 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009362 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009363
9364 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9365 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9366 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009367 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009368 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9369 } else {
9370 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9371 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9372 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009373 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009374 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009375 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009376 }
9377 }
9378
9379 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9380 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009381 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009382 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009383 return true;
9384}
9385
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009386// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9387// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9388//
9389Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9390 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9391 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9392 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009393 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009394
9395 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9396 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009397 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009398 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009399
9400 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9401 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9402
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009403 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009404 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9405 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9406
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009407 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009408 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009409 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9410 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009411 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009412
9413 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9414 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9415 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009416 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009417 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9418 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009419 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009420 break;
9421 }
9422
9423 if (NestTy) {
9424 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9425 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9426 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9427
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009428 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009429 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009430
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009431 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009432 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9433
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009434 // Add any result attributes.
9435 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009436 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009437
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009438 {
9439 unsigned Idx = 1;
9440 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9441 do {
9442 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009443 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009444 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9445 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9446 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9447 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009448 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009449 }
9450
9451 if (I == E)
9452 break;
9453
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009454 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009455 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009456 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009457 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009458 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009459
9460 ++Idx, ++I;
9461 } while (1);
9462 }
9463
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009464 // Add any function attributes.
9465 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9466 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9467
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009468 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9469 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009470 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009471
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009472 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009473 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9474
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009475 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009476 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009477 {
9478 unsigned Idx = 1;
9479 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9480 E = FTy->param_end();
9481
9482 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009483 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9484 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009485 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009486
9487 if (I == E)
9488 break;
9489
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009490 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009491 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009492
9493 ++Idx, ++I;
9494 } while (1);
9495 }
9496
9497 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9498 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9499 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009500 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009501 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9502 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009503 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009504
9505 Instruction *NewCaller;
9506 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009507 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9508 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9509 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9510 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009511 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009512 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009513 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009514 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9515 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009516 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9517 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9518 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9519 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009520 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009521 }
9522 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9523 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9524 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9525 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9526 return 0;
9527 }
9528 }
9529
9530 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9531 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9532 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9533 Constant *NewCallee =
9534 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9535 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9536 return CS.getInstruction();
9537}
9538
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009539/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9540/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9541/// and a single binop.
9542Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9543 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009544 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9545 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009546 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009547 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9548 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9549
9550 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9551 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009552
9553 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9554 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009555 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009556 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009557 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009558 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009559 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9560 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9561 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009562 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009563
9564 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9565 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9566 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9567 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9568 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009569
9570 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9571 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9572 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009573 }
9574
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009575 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9576
9577 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9578 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9579 // hide them behind a phi.
9580 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9581 return 0;
9582
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009583 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009584 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009585 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009586 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009587 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9588 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009589 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9590 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009591 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9592 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9593 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009594
9595 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009596 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9597 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009598 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9599 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009600 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9601 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9602 }
9603
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009604 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9605 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9606 if (NewLHS) {
9607 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9608 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9609 }
9610 if (NewRHS) {
9611 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9612 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9613 }
9614 }
9615
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009616 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009617 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009618 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009619 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009620 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009621 else {
9622 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009623 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009624 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009625}
9626
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009627/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9628/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9629/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9630/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009631///
9632/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9633/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9634/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009635static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9636 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9637
9638 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9639 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9640 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009641
9642 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9643 // profitable to do this xform.
9644 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9645 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9646 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9647 UI != E; ++UI) {
9648 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9649 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9650 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9651 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9652 }
9653 isAddressTaken = true;
9654 break;
9655 }
9656
9657 if (!isAddressTaken)
9658 return false;
9659 }
9660
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009661 return true;
9662}
9663
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009664
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009665// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9666// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9667// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9668Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9669 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9670
9671 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9672 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9673 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9674 // code size and simplifying code.
9675 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9676 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009677 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009678 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9679 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009680 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009681 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9682 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009683 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009684 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9685 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009686 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9687 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9688 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9689 // load and the PHI.
9690 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9691 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9692 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009693
9694 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9695 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9696 // the path through the other successor.
9697 if (isVolatile &&
9698 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9699 return 0;
9700
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009701 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009702 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009703 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9704 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9705 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009706 } else {
9707 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9708 }
9709
9710 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9711 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9712 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9713 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009714 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009715 return 0;
9716 if (CastSrcTy) {
9717 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9718 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009719 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009720 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9721 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009722 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9723 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9724 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9725 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009726
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009727 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9728 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9729 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009730 if (isVolatile &&
9731 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9732 return 0;
9733
9734
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009735 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9736 return 0;
9737 }
9738 }
9739
9740 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9741 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009742 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9743 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009744 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009745
9746 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9747 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009748
9749 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009750 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9751 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9752 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9753 InVal = 0;
9754 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9755 }
9756
9757 Value *PhiVal;
9758 if (InVal) {
9759 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9760 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9761 PhiVal = InVal;
9762 delete NewPN;
9763 } else {
9764 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9765 PhiVal = NewPN;
9766 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009767
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009768 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009769 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009770 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009771 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009772 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009773 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009774 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009775 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009776 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9777
9778 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9779 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9780 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9781 if (isVolatile)
9782 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9783 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9784
9785 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009786}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009787
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009788/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9789/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009790static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9791 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009792 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9793 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9794
9795 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009796 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009797 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009798
9799 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9800 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9801 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009802
9803 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9804 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009805
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009806 return false;
9807}
9808
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009809/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9810/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9811/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9812static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9813 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9814 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9815 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9816 return true;
9817
9818 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9819 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9820 return false;
9821
9822 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9823 // the value.
9824 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9825 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9826 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9827 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9828 return false;
9829 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9830 return false;
9831 }
9832
9833 return true;
9834}
9835
9836
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009837// PHINode simplification
9838//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009839Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009840 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009841 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009842
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009843 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9845
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009846 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9847 // reducing code size.
9848 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9849 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9850 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9851 return Result;
9852
9853 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9854 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9855 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009856 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9857 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9858 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009859 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009860 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9861 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9863 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009864
9865 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9866 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9867 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9868 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9869 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9870 // late.
9871 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9872 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9873 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9874 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9875 }
9876 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009877
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009878 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9879 // same value, for example:
9880 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9881 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9882 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9883 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9884 {
9885 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9886 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9887 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9888 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9889 ++InValNo;
9890
9891 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9892 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9893
9894 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9895 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9896 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9897 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9898 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9899 break;
9900 }
9901
9902 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9903 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9904 // the value.
9905 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9906 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9907 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9909 }
9910 }
9911 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009912 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009913}
9914
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009915static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9916 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9917 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009918 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9919 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009920 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9921 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9922 // used for address computation.
9923 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9924 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9925 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9926 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009927}
9928
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009929
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009930Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009931 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009932 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009933 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009934 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009936
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009937 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9939
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009940 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9941 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9942 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9943
9944 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009946
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009947 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9948 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009949
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009950 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009951 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9952 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009953 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009954 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009955 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9956 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9957 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9958 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9959 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9960 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9961 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009962 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009963 }
9964 }
9965 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009966 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +00009967 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
9968 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009969 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9970 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009971 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009972 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009973 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009974 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009975 MadeChange = true;
9976 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009977 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9978 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009979 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009980 MadeChange = true;
9981 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +00009982 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9983 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
9984 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
9985 MadeChange = true;
9986 } else {
9987 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9988 GEP);
9989 *i = Op;
9990 MadeChange = true;
9991 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009992 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009993 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009994 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009995 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9996
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009997 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9998 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9999 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010000 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10001 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10002 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10003 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10004 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10005 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010006 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10007 if (I != BCI) {
10008 I->takeName(BCI);
10009 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10010 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10011 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010012 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010013 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010014 }
10015 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10016 }
10017 }
10018
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010019 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10020 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10021 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10022 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010023 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010024 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010025 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010026
10027 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010028 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10029 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10030 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10031 //
10032 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10033 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10034 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10035
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010036 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010037
10038 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10039 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10040 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10041 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010042 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010043
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010044 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010045 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010046 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10047 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10048 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010049 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010050 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10051 Sum = GO1;
10052 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10053 Sum = SO1;
10054 } else {
10055 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10056 // target's pointer size.
10057 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10058 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010059 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010060 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010061 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010062 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010063 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10064 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010065 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010066 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010067
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010068 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010069 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010070 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010071 } else {
10072 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010073 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10074 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010075 }
10076 }
10077 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010078 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10079 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10080 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010081 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010082 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010083 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010084 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010085
10086 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10087 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10088 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10089 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10090 return &GEP;
10091 } else {
10092 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10093 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10094 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10095 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10096 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010097 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010098 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010099 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010100 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010101 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10102 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010103 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10104 }
10105
10106 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010107 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10108 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010109
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010110 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010111 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10112 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10113
10114 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010115 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010116 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10117 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10118 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10119
10120 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010121 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10122 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010123
10124 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10125 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10126 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010127 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010128 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10129 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10130 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010131 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10132 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010133 //
10134 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10135 //
10136 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10137 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10138 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10139 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10140 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10141 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10142 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10143 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10144 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10145 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10146 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10147 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10148 return &GEP;
10149 }
10150 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10151 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010152 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10153 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010154 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10155 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10156 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010157 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10158 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010159 Value *Idx[2];
10160 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10161 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010162 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010163 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010164 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10165 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010166 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010167
10168 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010169 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010170 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010171 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010172
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010173 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010174 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010175 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010176
10177 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10178 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10179 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10180 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10181 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10182 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10183 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10184 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010185 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010186 Scale = CI;
10187 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10188 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10189 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010190 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10191 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10192 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010193 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10194 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10195 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10196 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10197 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10198 }
10199 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010200
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010201 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010202 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10203 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10204 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10205 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10206 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10207 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10208 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010209 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010210 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010211 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010212 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010213 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10214 }
10215
10216 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010217 Value *Idx[2];
10218 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10219 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010220 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010221 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010222 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10223 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10224 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010225 }
10226 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010227 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010228 }
10229
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010230 return 0;
10231}
10232
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010233Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10234 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010235 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010236 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10237 const Type *NewTy =
10238 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010239 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010240
10241 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10242 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010243 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010244 else {
10245 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010246 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010247 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010248
10249 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010250
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010251 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10252 // allocas if possible...
10253 //
10254 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10255 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10256
10257 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10258 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10259 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010260 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010261 Value *Idx[2];
10262 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10263 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010264 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10265 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010266
10267 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10268 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010270 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010272 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010273 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010274
10275 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10276 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10277 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010278 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010279 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10281
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010282 return 0;
10283}
10284
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010285Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10286 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10287
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010288 // free undef -> unreachable.
10289 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10290 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010291 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010292 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010293 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10294 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010295
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010296 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10297 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010298 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010299 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010300
10301 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10302 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10303 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10304 return &FI;
10305 }
10306
10307 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10308 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10309 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10310 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10311 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10312 return &FI;
10313 }
10314 }
10315
10316 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10317 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10318 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10319 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10320 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10321 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010322
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010323 return 0;
10324}
10325
10326
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010327/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010328static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010329 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010330 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010331 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010332
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010333 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10334 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10335 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010336 std::string Str;
10337 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010338 unsigned len = Str.length();
10339 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10340 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10341 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10342 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010343 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10344 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10345 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10346 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10347 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10348 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10349 }
10350 } else {
10351 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10352 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10353 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10354 }
10355 // Append NULL at the end.
10356 SingleChar = 0;
10357 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10358 }
10359 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10360 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010361 }
10362 }
10363 }
10364
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010365 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010366 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010367 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010368
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010369 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010370 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010371 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10372 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10373 // constants.
10374 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10375 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10376 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010377 Value *Idxs[2];
10378 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10379 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010380 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10381 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10382 }
10383
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010384 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010385 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010386 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10387 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10388 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010389 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10390 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010391
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010392 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10393 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10394 // the result of the loaded value.
10395 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10396 CI->getName(),
10397 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10398 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010399 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010400 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010401 }
10402 }
10403 return 0;
10404}
10405
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010406/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010407/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10408/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10409/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10410static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010411 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10412 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10413
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010414 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010415 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010416 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010417 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010418
10419 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10420 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010421 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10422 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10423 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010424 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10425
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010426 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010427 --BBI;
10428
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010429 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10430 // marked invalid.
10431 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10432 return false;
10433
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010434 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10435 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010436 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010437 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010438 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010439
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010440 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010441 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010442}
10443
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010444Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10445 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010446
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010447 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010448 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10449 if (KnownAlign >
10450 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10451 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010452 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10453
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010454 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010455 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010456 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010457 return Res;
10458
10459 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10460 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010461
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010462 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10463 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010464 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10465 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010466 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10467 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010469 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10470 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010472 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010473
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010474 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10475 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10476 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10477 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10478 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010479 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10480 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10481 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10482 // CFG.
10483 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10484 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10485 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10486 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010487 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010488
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010489 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010490 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010491 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10492 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10493 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010494 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10495 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10496 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010497 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10498 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010500 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010501
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010502 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10503 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010504 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010505 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010506
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010507 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010508 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010509 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10510 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010511 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010512 if (Constant *V =
10513 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010515 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10516 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10517 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10518 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10519 // CFG.
10520 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10521 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10523 }
10524
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010525 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010526 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010527 return Res;
10528 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010529 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010530 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010531
10532 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10533 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010534 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010535 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10536 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10538 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10539 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10540 }
10541 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010542
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010543 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010544 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10545 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10546 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10547 //
10548 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10549 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10550 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10551 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10552 // unconditionally.
10553 //
10554 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10555 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010556 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10557 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010558 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010559 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010560 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010561 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010562 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010563 }
10564
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010565 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10566 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10567 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10568 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10569 return &LI;
10570 }
10571
10572 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10573 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10574 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10575 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10576 return &LI;
10577 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010578 }
10579 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010580 return 0;
10581}
10582
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010583/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010584/// when possible.
10585static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10586 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10587 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10588
10589 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10590 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10591 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10592
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010593 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010594 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10595 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10596 // constants.
10597 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10598 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10599 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010600 Value* Idxs[2];
10601 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10602 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010603 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10604 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10605 }
10606
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010607 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10608 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10609 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010610
10611 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010612 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10613 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010614 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010615 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010616 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10617 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10618 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10619 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10620 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010621 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010622 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010623 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010624 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10625 }
10626 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010627 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010628 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010629 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010630 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010631 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010632 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10633 }
10634 }
10635 }
10636 return 0;
10637}
10638
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010639Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10640 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10641 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10642
10643 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010644 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010645 ++NumCombined;
10646 return 0;
10647 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010648
10649 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10650 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010651 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010652 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10653 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10654 ++NumCombined;
10655 return 0;
10656 }
10657
10658 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10659 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10660 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10661 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10662 ++NumCombined;
10663 return 0;
10664 }
10665 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010666
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010667 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010668 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10669 if (KnownAlign >
10670 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10671 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010672 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10673
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010674 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10675 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10676 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10677 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10678 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10679 --ScanInsts) {
10680 --BBI;
10681
10682 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10683 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10684 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10685 ++NumDeadStore;
10686 ++BBI;
10687 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10688 continue;
10689 }
10690 break;
10691 }
10692
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010693 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10694 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10695 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10696 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010697 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010698 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10699 ++NumCombined;
10700 return 0;
10701 }
10702 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10703 // may not be dead.
10704 break;
10705 }
10706
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010707 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010708 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010709 break;
10710 }
10711
10712
10713 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010714
10715 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10716 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10717 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10718 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10719 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010720 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010721 ++NumCombined;
10722 }
10723 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10724 }
10725
10726 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10727 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010728 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010729 ++NumCombined;
10730 return 0;
10731 }
10732
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010733 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10734 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010735 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010736 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10737 return Res;
10738 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010739 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010740 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10741 return Res;
10742
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010743
10744 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10745 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010746 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010747 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010748 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10749 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10750 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010751
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010752 return 0;
10753}
10754
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010755/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10756/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10757/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10758///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010759/// Simplify things like:
10760/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10761/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10762///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010763bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10764 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10765
10766 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10767 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10768 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010769 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010770
10771 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10772 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010773 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10774 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010775 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010776 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010777 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010778 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010779 return false;
10780
10781 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010782 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010783 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010784 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010785 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010786 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010787 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010788
10789 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10790 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10791 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10792 return false;
10793
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010794 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10795 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010796 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010797 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010798 return false;
10799
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010800 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10801 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10802 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10803 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10804 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10805 --BBI;
10806 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10807 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10808 return false;
10809 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010810 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010811 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10812 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10813 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10814 return false;
10815
10816 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010817 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10818 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010819 for (;; --BBI) {
10820 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10821 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10822 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10823 return false;
10824 break;
10825 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010826 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10827 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10828 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010829 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10830 return false;
10831 }
10832
10833 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010834 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10835 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010836 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10837 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010838 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010839 return false;
10840 }
10841 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010842
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010843 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010844 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10845 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010846 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010847 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10848 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010849 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10850 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010851 }
10852
10853 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10854 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010855 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010856 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10857 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10858
10859 // Nuke the old stores.
10860 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10861 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10862 ++NumCombined;
10863 return true;
10864}
10865
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010866
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010867Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10868 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010869 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010870 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10871 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10872 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10873 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10874 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10875 BI.setCondition(X);
10876 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10877 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10878 return &BI;
10879 }
10880
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010881 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10882 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10883 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10884 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10885 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10886 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10887 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010888 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010889 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10890 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010891 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10892 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10893 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10894 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010895 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010896 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010897 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010898 return &BI;
10899 }
10900
10901 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10902 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10903 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10904 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10905 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10906 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10907 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10908 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010909 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010910 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10911 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010912 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010913 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010914 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10915 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010916 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010917 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010918 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010919 return &BI;
10920 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010921
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010922 return 0;
10923}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010924
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010925Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10926 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10927 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10928 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10929 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10930 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10931 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010932 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010933 AddRHS));
10934 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010935 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010936 return &SI;
10937 }
10938 }
10939 return 0;
10940}
10941
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010942Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010943 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010944
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010945 if (!EV.hasIndices())
10946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
10947
10948 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
10949 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
10950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
10951
10952 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
10953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
10954
10955 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
10956 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
10957 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
10958 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
10959 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
10960 // first index
10961 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
10962 else
10963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
10964 }
10965 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
10966 }
10967 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
10968 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
10969 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
10970 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
10971 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
10972 exti != exte && insi != inse;
10973 ++exti, ++insi) {
10974 if (*insi != *exti)
10975 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
10976 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
10977 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
10978 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
10979 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10980 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
10981 // with
10982 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
10983 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10984 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
10985 }
10986 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
10987 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
10988 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10989 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
10990 // with "i32 42"
10991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
10992 if (exti == exte) {
10993 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
10994 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10995 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
10996 // with
10997 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
10998 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
10999 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11000 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11001 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11002 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11003 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11004 EV);
11005 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11006 insi, inse);
11007 }
11008 if (insi == inse)
11009 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11010 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11011 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11012 // i.e., replace
11013 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11014 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11015 // with
11016 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11017 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11018 exti, exte);
11019 }
11020 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11021 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11022 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11023 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011024 return 0;
11025}
11026
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011027/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11028/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11029static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11030 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11031 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011032 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011033 if (isConstant) return true;
11034 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11035 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11036 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11037 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11038 return false;
11039 return true;
11040 }
11041 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11042 if (!I) return false;
11043
11044 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11045 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11046 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11047 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11048 return true;
11049 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11050 return true;
11051 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11052 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11053 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11054 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11055 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011056 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11057 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11058 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11059 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11060 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011061
11062 return false;
11063}
11064
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011065/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11066///
11067/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11068/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011069static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11070 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11071 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11072 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11073 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11074 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11075
11076 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011077 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011078 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11079 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011080 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11081 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011082 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011083 return Result;
11084}
11085
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011086/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11087/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11088/// extracted from the vector.
11089static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011090 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11091 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011092 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11093 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011094 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11095
11096 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11097 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11098 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11099 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011100 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011101 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11102 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11103 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011104 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11105 return 0;
11106 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011107
11108 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11109 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011110 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11111 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011112
11113 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11114 // vector input.
11115 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011116 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011117 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
11118 if (InEl < Width)
11119 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
11120 else if (InEl < Width*2)
11121 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
11122 else
11123 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011124 }
11125
11126 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11127 return 0;
11128}
11129
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011130Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011131 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011132 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11133 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11134
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011135 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011136 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11137 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11138
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011139 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011140 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11141 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11142 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011143 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011144 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011145 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11146 op0 = 0;
11147 break;
11148 }
11149 if (op0)
11150 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011151 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011152
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011153 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11154 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011155 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011156 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11157 unsigned VectorWidth =
11158 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11159
11160 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11161 // crashing the code below.
11162 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11164
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011165 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11166 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11167 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011168 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011169 uint64_t UndefElts;
11170 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011171 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011172 UndefElts)) {
11173 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11174 return &EI;
11175 }
11176 }
11177
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011178 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011180
11181 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11182 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11183 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11184 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11185 if (const VectorType *VT =
11186 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11187 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11188 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11189 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11190 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011191 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011192
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011193 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011194 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11195 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11196 // profitable to do so
11197 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011198 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11199 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11200 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11201 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11202 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11203 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11204 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11205 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11206 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11207 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011208 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011209 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011210 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011211 unsigned AS =
11212 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011213 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11214 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011215 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11216 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011217 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11218 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011219 }
11220 }
11221 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11222 // Extracting the inserted element?
11223 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11224 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11225 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11226 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11227 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11228 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11229 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11230 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11231 return &EI;
11232 }
11233 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11234 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11235 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011236 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11237 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011238 Value *Src;
11239 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11240 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11241 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11242 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11243 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11244 } else {
11245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011246 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011247 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011248 }
11249 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011250 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011251 return 0;
11252}
11253
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011254/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11255/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11256/// Otherwise, return false.
11257static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11258 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11259 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11260 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011261 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011262
11263 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011264 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011265 return true;
11266 } else if (V == LHS) {
11267 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011268 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011269 return true;
11270 } else if (V == RHS) {
11271 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011272 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011273 return true;
11274 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11275 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11276 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11277 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11278 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11279
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011280 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11281 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011282 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011283
11284 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11285 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11286 // transitively ok.
11287 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11288 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011289 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011290 return true;
11291 }
11292 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11293 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011294 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11295 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011296 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011297
11298 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11299 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11300 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11301 // transitively ok.
11302 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11303 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11304 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011305 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011306 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011307 } else {
11308 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011309 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011310 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011311
11312 }
11313 return true;
11314 }
11315 }
11316 }
11317 }
11318 }
11319 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11320
11321 return false;
11322}
11323
11324/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11325/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11326/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011327static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011328 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011329 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011330 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011331 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011332 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011333
11334 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011335 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011336 return V;
11337 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011338 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011339 return V;
11340 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11341 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11342 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11343 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11344 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11345
11346 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11347 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11348 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11349 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011350 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11351 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011352
11353 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11354 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011355 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11356 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11357 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011358 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011359 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011360 return V;
11361 }
11362
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011363 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11364 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011365 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11366 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11367 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011368 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011369 }
11370 return V;
11371 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011372
11373 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11374 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11375 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11376 return EI->getOperand(0);
11377
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011378 }
11379 }
11380 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011381 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011382
11383 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11384 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011385 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011386 return V;
11387}
11388
11389Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11390 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11391 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11392 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11393
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011394 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11395 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11396 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11397
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011398 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11399 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11400 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11401 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11402 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11403 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011404 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11405 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011406 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011407
11408 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11409 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11410
11411 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11413
11414 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11415 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11416 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11418
11419 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11420 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11421 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11422 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11423 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11424 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11425 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11426 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11427 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11428 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011429 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011430 else {
11431 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011432 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011433 NumVectorElts));
11434 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011435 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011436 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011437 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011438 }
11439
11440 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11441 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11442 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11443 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011444 Value *RHS = 0;
11445 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11446 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11447 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011448 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011449 }
11450 }
11451 }
11452
11453 return 0;
11454}
11455
11456
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011457Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11458 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11459 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011460 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011461
11462 bool MadeChange = false;
11463
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011464 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011465 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011467
11468 uint64_t UndefElts;
11469 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
11470 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11471 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011472 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11473 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11474 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011475 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011476 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011477
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011478 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11479 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11480 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11481 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011482 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11483 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11484 }
11485
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011486 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11487 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11488 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011489 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011490 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011491 else {
11492 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011493 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011494 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011495 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11496 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011497 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011498 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11499 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011500 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011501 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011502 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011503 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011504 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011505 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11506 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011507 MadeChange = true;
11508 }
11509
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011510 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011511 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011512
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011513 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11514 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11515 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11516 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11517
11518 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11519 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011520 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011521
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011522 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11523 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11524 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011525
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011526 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11527 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11528 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11529 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11530 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11531 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11532 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11533 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11534 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11535 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11536 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11537 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11538
11539 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11540 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11541 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11542 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11543 else
11544 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11545
11546 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11547 // the replacement.
11548 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11549 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11550 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11551 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011552 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011553 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011554 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011555 }
11556 }
11557 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11558 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011559 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011560 }
11561 }
11562 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011563
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011564 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11565}
11566
11567
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011568
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011569
11570/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11571/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11572/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11573/// end of its block.
11574static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11575 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11576
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011577 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011578 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11579 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011580
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011581 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011582 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11583 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011584 return false;
11585
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011586 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11587 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011588 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11589 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011590 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11591 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11592 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011593 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011594
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011595 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011596
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011597 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011598 ++NumSunkInst;
11599 return true;
11600}
11601
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011602
11603/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11604/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11605///
11606/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11607/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11608/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11609/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11610/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11611///
11612static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011613 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011614 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011615 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011616 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011617 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011618
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011619 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11620 BB = Worklist.back();
11621 Worklist.pop_back();
11622
11623 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11624 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11625
11626 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11627 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011628
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011629 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11630 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11631 ++NumDeadInst;
11632 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11633 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11634 continue;
11635 }
11636
11637 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11638 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11639 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11640 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11641 ++NumConstProp;
11642 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11643 continue;
11644 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011645
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011646 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011647 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011648
11649 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11650 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11651 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11652 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11653 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11654 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011655 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011656 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011657 continue;
11658 }
11659 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11660 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11661 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11662 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11663 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011664 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011665 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011666 continue;
11667 }
11668
11669 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11670 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11671 continue;
11672 }
11673 }
11674
11675 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11676 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011677 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011678}
11679
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011680bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011681 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011682 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011683
11684 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11685 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011686
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011687 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011688 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11689 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11690 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011691 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011692 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011693
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011694 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11695 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11696 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11697 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11698 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11699 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11700 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11701 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011702
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011703 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011704 ++NumDeadInst;
11705
11706 if (!I->use_empty())
11707 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11708 I->eraseFromParent();
11709 }
11710 }
11711 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011712
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011713 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11714 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11715 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011716
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011717 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011718 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011719 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011720 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011721 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011722 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011723
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011724 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011725
11726 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011727 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011728 continue;
11729 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011730
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011731 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011732 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011733 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011734
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011735 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011736 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011737 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11738
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011739 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011740 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011741 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011742 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011743 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011744
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011745 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11746 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11747 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11748 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11749 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11750 i->set(NewC);
11751 }
11752 }
11753 }
11754
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011755 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011756 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011757 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11758 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11759 if (UserParent != BB) {
11760 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11761 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11762 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11763 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11764 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11765 break;
11766 }
11767
11768 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11769 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11770 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11771 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11772 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11773 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11774 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11775 }
11776 }
11777
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011778 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011779#ifndef NDEBUG
11780 std::string OrigI;
11781#endif
11782 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011783 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011784 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011785 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011786 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011787 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11788 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011789
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011790 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11791 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11792
11793 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011794 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011795 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011796
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011797 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11798 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011799
11800 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11801 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011802 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11803
11804 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11805 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11806 ++InsertPos;
11807
11808 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011809
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011810 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11811 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011812 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011813
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011814 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11815 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011816 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011817
11818 // Erase the old instruction.
11819 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011820 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011821#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011822 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11823 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011824#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011825
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011826 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11827 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011828 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11829 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11830 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011831 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011832
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011833 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011834 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011835 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011836 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011837 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011838 AddToWorkList(I);
11839 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011840 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011841 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011842 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011843 }
11844 }
11845
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011846 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011847
11848 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11849 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011850 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011851}
11852
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011853
11854bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011855 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11856
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011857 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11858
11859 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11860 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011861 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011862 EverMadeChange = true;
11863 return EverMadeChange;
11864}
11865
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011866FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011867 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011868}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011869
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000011870